Mercurial > repos > blastem
annotate nuklear_ui/blastem_nuklear.c @ 2317:e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
author | Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com> |
---|---|
date | Sun, 02 Apr 2023 23:21:39 -0700 |
parents | ef5dc4d02d27 |
children | ab3d8759da08 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
1 #define NK_IMPLEMENTATION |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2 #define NK_SDL_GLES2_IMPLEMENTATION |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
3 #define NK_RAWFB_IMPLEMENTATION |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
4 #define RAWFB_RGBX_8888 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
5 |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
6 #include <stdlib.h> |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
7 #include <limits.h> |
1827 | 8 #include <math.h> |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
9 #include "blastem_nuklear.h" |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
10 #include "nuklear_rawfb.h" |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
11 #include "font.h" |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
12 #include "../render.h" |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
13 #include "../render_sdl.h" |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
14 #include "../util.h" |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
15 #include "../paths.h" |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
16 #include "../saves.h" |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
17 #include "../blastem.h" |
1485
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
18 #include "../config.h" |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
19 #include "../io.h" |
1569
0ec89dadb36d
Add code for loading PNG images. Added 360 controller image. WIP work on gamepad mapping UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1568
diff
changeset
|
20 #include "../png.h" |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
21 #include "../controller_info.h" |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
22 #include "../bindings.h" |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
23 |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
24 static struct nk_context *context; |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
25 static struct rawfb_context *fb_context; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
26 |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
27 typedef struct |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
28 { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
29 uint32_t *image_data; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
30 uint32_t width, height; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
31 struct nk_image ui; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
32 } ui_image; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
33 |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
34 static ui_image **ui_images, *controller_360, *controller_ps4, |
2020
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
35 *controller_ps4_6b, *controller_wiiu, *controller_gen_6b; |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
36 static uint32_t num_ui_images, ui_image_storage; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
37 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
38 typedef void (*view_fun)(struct nk_context *); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
39 static view_fun current_view; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
40 static view_fun *previous_views; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
41 static uint32_t view_storage; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
42 static uint32_t num_prev; |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
43 static struct nk_font *def_font; |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
44 static uint8_t config_dirty; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
45 |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
46 static void push_view(view_fun new_view) |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
47 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
48 if (num_prev == view_storage) { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
49 view_storage = view_storage ? 2*view_storage : 2; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
50 previous_views = realloc(previous_views, view_storage*sizeof(view_fun)); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
51 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
52 previous_views[num_prev++] = current_view; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
53 current_view = new_view; |
1841
5d10b8494b02
WIP keyboard nav for Nuklear menus
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1831
diff
changeset
|
54 context->input.selected_widget = 0; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
55 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
56 |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
57 static void pop_view() |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
58 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
59 if (num_prev) { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
60 current_view = previous_views[--num_prev]; |
1841
5d10b8494b02
WIP keyboard nav for Nuklear menus
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1831
diff
changeset
|
61 context->input.selected_widget = 0; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
62 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
63 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
64 |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
65 static void clear_view_stack() |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
66 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
67 num_prev = 0; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
68 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
69 |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
70 void view_play(struct nk_context *context) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
71 { |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
72 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
73 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
74 |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
75 static char *browser_cur_path; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
76 static const char *browser_label; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
77 static const char *browser_setting_path; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
78 static const char **browser_ext_list; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
79 static uint32_t browser_num_exts; |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
80 void view_file_browser(struct nk_context *context, uint8_t normal_open) |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
81 { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
82 static dir_entry *entries; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
83 static size_t num_entries; |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
84 static int32_t selected_entry = -1; |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
85 static const char **ext_list; |
1485
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
86 static uint32_t num_exts; |
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
87 static uint8_t got_ext_list; |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
88 if (!browser_cur_path) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
89 get_initial_browse_path(&browser_cur_path); |
1481
77a401044935
Fix directory navigation in ROM file chooser in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1478
diff
changeset
|
90 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
91 if (!entries) { |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
92 entries = get_dir_list(browser_cur_path, &num_entries); |
1484
d82af64c94d2
Sort directory listing in Nuklear UI file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1483
diff
changeset
|
93 if (entries) { |
d82af64c94d2
Sort directory listing in Nuklear UI file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1483
diff
changeset
|
94 sort_dir_list(entries, num_entries); |
d82af64c94d2
Sort directory listing in Nuklear UI file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1483
diff
changeset
|
95 } |
2017
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
96 if (!num_entries) { |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
97 //get_dir_list can fail if the user doesn't have permission |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
98 //for the current folder, make sure they can still navigate up |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
99 free_dir_list(entries, num_entries); |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
100 entries = calloc(1, sizeof(dir_entry)); |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
101 entries[0].name = strdup(".."); |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
102 entries[0].is_dir = 1; |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
103 num_entries = 1; |
8e7b06ade815
Prevent user from getting stuck in directories they don't have permission to read in ROM browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2016
diff
changeset
|
104 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
105 } |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
106 if (!browser_ext_list) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
107 if (!got_ext_list) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
108 ext_list = (const char **)get_extension_list(config, &num_exts); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
109 got_ext_list = 1; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
110 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
111 browser_ext_list = ext_list; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
112 browser_num_exts = num_exts; |
1485
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
113 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
114 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
115 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
116 if (nk_begin(context, "Load ROM", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
117 nk_layout_row_static(context, height - context->style.font->height * 3, width - 60, 1); |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
118 int32_t old_selected = selected_entry; |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
119 const char *parts[] = {browser_label, ": ", browser_cur_path}; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
120 char *title = alloc_concat_m(3, parts); |
2016
2d8748e0ccb2
Show current path in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2015
diff
changeset
|
121 if (nk_group_begin(context, title, NK_WINDOW_BORDER | NK_WINDOW_TITLE)) { |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
122 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height - 2, width-100, 1); |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
123 for (int32_t i = 0; i < num_entries; i++) |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
124 { |
1485
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
125 if (entries[i].name[0] == '.' && entries[i].name[1] != '.') { |
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
126 continue; |
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
127 } |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
128 if (browser_num_exts && !entries[i].is_dir && !path_matches_extensions(entries[i].name, browser_ext_list, browser_num_exts)) { |
1485
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
129 continue; |
369da70ee2c2
Filter file list in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1484
diff
changeset
|
130 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
131 int selected = i == selected_entry; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
132 nk_selectable_label(context, entries[i].name, NK_TEXT_ALIGN_LEFT, &selected); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
133 if (selected) { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
134 selected_entry = i; |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
135 } else if (i == selected_entry) { |
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
136 selected_entry = -1; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
137 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
138 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
139 nk_group_end(context); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
140 } |
2016
2d8748e0ccb2
Show current path in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2015
diff
changeset
|
141 free(title); |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
142 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.75, width > 600 ? 300 : width / 2, 2); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
143 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
144 browser_ext_list = NULL; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
145 pop_view(); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
146 } |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
147 if (nk_button_label(context, "Open") || (old_selected >= 0 && selected_entry < 0)) { |
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
148 if (selected_entry < 0) { |
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
149 selected_entry = old_selected; |
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
150 } |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
151 char *full_path = path_append(browser_cur_path, entries[selected_entry].name); |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
152 if (entries[selected_entry].is_dir) { |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
153 free(browser_cur_path); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
154 browser_cur_path = full_path; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
155 free_dir_list(entries, num_entries); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
156 entries = NULL; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
157 } else { |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
158 if(normal_open) { |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
159 if (current_system) { |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
160 current_system->next_rom = full_path; |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
161 current_system->request_exit(current_system); |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
162 } else { |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
163 init_system_with_media(full_path, SYSTEM_UNKNOWN); |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
164 free(full_path); |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
165 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
166 |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
167 clear_view_stack(); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
168 show_play_view(); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
169 } else if (browser_setting_path) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
170 config = tern_insert_path(config, browser_setting_path, (tern_val){.ptrval = full_path}, TVAL_PTR); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
171 config_dirty = 1; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
172 browser_ext_list = NULL; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
173 pop_view(); |
1483
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
174 } else { |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
175 lockon_media(full_path); |
1483
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
176 free(full_path); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
177 |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
178 clear_view_stack(); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
179 show_play_view(); |
1483
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
180 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
181 } |
1554
87350caf6dab
Allow double click to open ROM in file browser
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1553
diff
changeset
|
182 selected_entry = -1; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
183 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
184 nk_end(context); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
185 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
186 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
187 |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
188 void view_load(struct nk_context *context) |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
189 { |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
190 browser_label = "Select ROM"; |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
191 view_file_browser(context, 1); |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
192 } |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
193 |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
194 void view_lock_on(struct nk_context *context) |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
195 { |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
196 browser_label = "Select ROM"; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
197 view_file_browser(context, 0); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
198 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
199 |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
200 void view_file_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
201 { |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
202 view_file_browser(context, 0); |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
203 } |
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
204 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
205 void view_about(struct nk_context *context) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
206 { |
1526 | 207 const char *lines[] = { |
1815
7f4fac75b484
Update version number for nightly builds
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1814
diff
changeset
|
208 "BlastEm v0.6.3-pre", |
1812
8aeac7bd9fa7
Update version number, special thanks, CHANGELOG and README in preparation for possible 0.6.2 release
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1811
diff
changeset
|
209 "Copyright 2012-2019 Michael Pavone", |
1526 | 210 "", |
211 "BlastEm is a high performance open source", | |
212 "(GPLv3) Genesis/Megadrive emulator", | |
213 }; | |
214 const uint32_t NUM_LINES = sizeof(lines)/sizeof(*lines); | |
215 const char *thanks[] = { | |
1661 | 216 "Nemesis: Documentation and test ROMs", |
1526 | 217 "Charles MacDonald: Documentation", |
218 "Eke-Eke: Documentation", | |
1812
8aeac7bd9fa7
Update version number, special thanks, CHANGELOG and README in preparation for possible 0.6.2 release
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1811
diff
changeset
|
219 "Sauraen: YM2612/YM2203 Die Analysis", |
8aeac7bd9fa7
Update version number, special thanks, CHANGELOG and README in preparation for possible 0.6.2 release
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1811
diff
changeset
|
220 "Alexey Khokholov: YM3438 Die Analysis", |
1526 | 221 "Bart Trzynadlowski: Documentation", |
222 "KanedaFR: Hosting the best Sega forum", | |
223 "Titan: Awesome demos and documentation", | |
1661 | 224 "flamewing: BCD info and test ROM", |
225 "r57shell: Opcode size test ROM", | |
1526 | 226 "micky: Testing", |
227 "Sasha: Testing", | |
228 "lol-frank: Testing", | |
229 "Sik: Testing", | |
230 "Tim Lawrence : Testing", | |
231 "ComradeOj: Testing", | |
232 "Vladikcomper: Testing" | |
233 }; | |
234 const uint32_t NUM_THANKS = sizeof(thanks)/sizeof(*thanks); | |
235 uint32_t width = render_width(); | |
236 uint32_t height = render_height(); | |
237 if (nk_begin(context, "About", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { | |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
238 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, width-40, 1); |
1526 | 239 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < NUM_LINES; i++) |
240 { | |
241 nk_label(context, lines[i], NK_TEXT_LEFT); | |
242 } | |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
243 nk_layout_row_static(context, height - (context->style.font->height * 2 + 20) - (context->style.font->height +4)*NUM_LINES, width-40, 1); |
1526 | 244 if (nk_group_begin(context, "Special Thanks", NK_WINDOW_TITLE)) { |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
245 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, width - 80, 1); |
1526 | 246 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < NUM_THANKS; i++) |
247 { | |
248 nk_label(context, thanks[i], NK_TEXT_LEFT); | |
249 } | |
250 nk_group_end(context); | |
251 } | |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
252 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.75, width/3, 1); |
1526 | 253 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
254 pop_view(); | |
255 } | |
256 nk_end(context); | |
257 } | |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
258 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
259 |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
260 typedef struct { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
261 const char *title; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
262 view_fun next_view; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
263 } menu_item; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
264 |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
265 static save_slot_info *slots; |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
266 static uint32_t num_slots, selected_slot; |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
267 |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
268 void view_choose_state(struct nk_context *context, uint8_t is_load) |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
269 { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
270 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
271 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
272 if (nk_begin(context, "Slot Picker", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
273 nk_layout_row_static(context, height - context->style.font->height * 3, width - 60, 1); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
274 if (nk_group_begin(context, "Select Save Slot", NK_WINDOW_BORDER | NK_WINDOW_TITLE)) { |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
275 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height - 2, width-100, 1); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
276 if (!slots) { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
277 slots = get_slot_info(current_system, &num_slots); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
278 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
279 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_slots; i++) |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
280 { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
281 int selected = i == selected_slot; |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
282 nk_selectable_label(context, slots[i].desc, NK_TEXT_ALIGN_LEFT, &selected); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
283 if (selected && (slots[i].modification_time || !is_load)) { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
284 selected_slot = i; |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
285 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
286 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
287 nk_group_end(context); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
288 } |
1579
f66290afae65
Add some basic scaling to rest of UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1578
diff
changeset
|
289 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.75, width > 600 ? 300 : width / 2, 2); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
290 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
291 pop_view(); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
292 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
293 if (is_load) { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
294 if (nk_button_label(context, "Load")) { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
295 current_system->load_state(current_system, selected_slot); |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
296 show_play_view(); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
297 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
298 } else { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
299 if (nk_button_label(context, "Save")) { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
300 current_system->save_state = selected_slot + 1; |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
301 show_play_view(); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
302 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
303 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
304 nk_end(context); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
305 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
306 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
307 |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
308 void view_save_state(struct nk_context *context) |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
309 { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
310 view_choose_state(context, 0); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
311 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
312 |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
313 void view_load_state(struct nk_context *context) |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
314 { |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
315 view_choose_state(context, 1); |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
316 } |
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
317 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
318 typedef void (*menu_handler)(uint32_t index); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
319 |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
320 static void menu(struct nk_context *context, uint32_t num_entries, const menu_item *items, menu_handler handler) |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
321 { |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
322 const uint32_t button_height = context->style.font->height * 1.75; |
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
323 const uint32_t ideal_button_width = context->style.font->height * 10; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
324 const uint32_t button_space = 6; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
325 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
326 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
327 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
328 uint32_t top = height/2 - (button_height * num_entries)/2; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
329 uint32_t button_width = width > ideal_button_width ? ideal_button_width : width; |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
330 uint32_t left = width/2 - button_width/2; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
331 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
332 nk_layout_space_begin(context, NK_STATIC, top + button_height * num_entries, num_entries); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
333 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_entries; i++) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
334 { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
335 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(left, top + i * button_height, button_width, button_height-button_space)); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
336 if (nk_button_label(context, items[i].title)) { |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
337 if (items[i].next_view) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
338 push_view(items[i].next_view); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
339 if (current_view == view_save_state || current_view == view_load_state) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
340 free_slot_info(slots); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
341 slots = NULL; |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
342 } else if (current_view == view_play) { |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
343 clear_view_stack(); |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
344 set_content_binding_state(1); |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
345 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
346 } else { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
347 handler(i); |
1478
da1dce39e846
Refactored save slot related logic to reduce duplication and allow reuse in new UI. Get state loading/saving mostly working in new UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1477
diff
changeset
|
348 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
349 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
350 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
351 nk_layout_space_end(context); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
352 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
353 |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
354 void binding_loop(char *key, tern_val val, uint8_t valtype, void *data) |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
355 { |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
356 if (valtype != TVAL_PTR) { |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
357 return; |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
358 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
359 tern_node **binding_lookup = data; |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
360 *binding_lookup = tern_insert_ptr(*binding_lookup, val.ptrval, strdup(key)); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
361 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
362 |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
363 static int32_t keycode; |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
364 static const char *set_binding; |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
365 static uint8_t bind_click_release, click; |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
366 char *set_label; |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
367 void binding_group(struct nk_context *context, char *name, const char **binds, const char **bind_names, uint32_t num_binds, tern_node *binding_lookup) |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
368 { |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
369 nk_layout_row_static(context, (context->style.font->height + 4)*num_binds+context->style.font->height+30, render_width() - 80, 1); |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
370 if (nk_group_begin(context, name, NK_WINDOW_TITLE)) { |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
371 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, render_width()/2 - 80, 2); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
372 |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
373 for (int i = 0; i < num_binds; i++) |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
374 { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
375 char *label_alloc = bind_names ? NULL : path_extension(binds[i]); |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
376 const char *label = label_alloc; |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
377 if (!label) { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
378 label = bind_names ? bind_names[i] : binds[i]; |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
379 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
380 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
381 if (nk_button_label(context, tern_find_ptr_default(binding_lookup, binds[i], "Not Set"))) { |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
382 set_binding = binds[i]; |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
383 set_label = strdup(label); |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
384 bind_click_release = 0; |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
385 keycode = 0; |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
386 } |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
387 if (label_alloc) { |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
388 free(label_alloc); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
389 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
390 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
391 nk_group_end(context); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
392 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
393 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
394 |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
395 static char *get_key_name(int32_t keycode) |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
396 { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
397 char *name = NULL; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
398 if (keycode > ' ' && keycode < 0x80) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
399 //key corresponds to a printable non-whitespace character |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
400 name = malloc(2); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
401 name[0] = keycode; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
402 name[1] = 0; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
403 } else { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
404 switch (keycode) |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
405 { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
406 case RENDERKEY_UP: name = "up"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
407 case RENDERKEY_DOWN: name = "down"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
408 case RENDERKEY_LEFT: name = "left"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
409 case RENDERKEY_RIGHT: name = "right"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
410 case '\r': name = "enter"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
411 case ' ': name = "space"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
412 case '\t': name = "tab"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
413 case '\b': name = "backspace"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
414 case RENDERKEY_ESC: name = "esc"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
415 case RENDERKEY_DEL: name = "delete"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
416 case RENDERKEY_LSHIFT: name = "lshift"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
417 case RENDERKEY_RSHIFT: name = "rshift"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
418 case RENDERKEY_LCTRL: name = "lctrl"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
419 case RENDERKEY_RCTRL: name = "rctrl"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
420 case RENDERKEY_LALT: name = "lalt"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
421 case RENDERKEY_RALT: name = "ralt"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
422 case RENDERKEY_HOME: name = "home"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
423 case RENDERKEY_END: name = "end"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
424 case RENDERKEY_PAGEUP: name = "pageup"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
425 case RENDERKEY_PAGEDOWN: name = "pagedown"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
426 case RENDERKEY_F1: name = "f1"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
427 case RENDERKEY_F2: name = "f2"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
428 case RENDERKEY_F3: name = "f3"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
429 case RENDERKEY_F4: name = "f4"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
430 case RENDERKEY_F5: name = "f5"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
431 case RENDERKEY_F6: name = "f6"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
432 case RENDERKEY_F7: name = "f7"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
433 case RENDERKEY_F8: name = "f8"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
434 case RENDERKEY_F9: name = "f9"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
435 case RENDERKEY_F10: name = "f10"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
436 case RENDERKEY_F11: name = "f11"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
437 case RENDERKEY_F12: name = "f12"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
438 case RENDERKEY_SELECT: name = "select"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
439 case RENDERKEY_PLAY: name = "play"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
440 case RENDERKEY_SEARCH: name = "search"; break; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
441 case RENDERKEY_BACK: name = "back"; break; |
1549
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
442 case RENDERKEY_NP0: name = "np0"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
443 case RENDERKEY_NP1: name = "np1"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
444 case RENDERKEY_NP2: name = "np2"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
445 case RENDERKEY_NP3: name = "np3"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
446 case RENDERKEY_NP4: name = "np4"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
447 case RENDERKEY_NP5: name = "np5"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
448 case RENDERKEY_NP6: name = "np6"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
449 case RENDERKEY_NP7: name = "np7"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
450 case RENDERKEY_NP8: name = "np8"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
451 case RENDERKEY_NP9: name = "np9"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
452 case RENDERKEY_NP_DIV: name = "np/"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
453 case RENDERKEY_NP_MUL: name = "np*"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
454 case RENDERKEY_NP_MIN: name = "np-"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
455 case RENDERKEY_NP_PLUS: name = "np+"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
456 case RENDERKEY_NP_ENTER: name = "npenter"; break; |
577253765192
Allow numpad keys to be mapped
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1545
diff
changeset
|
457 case RENDERKEY_NP_STOP: name = "np."; break; |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
458 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
459 if (name) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
460 name = strdup(name); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
461 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
462 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
463 return name; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
464 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
465 |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
466 void view_key_bindings(struct nk_context *context) |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
467 { |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
468 static const char *controller1_binds[] = { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
469 "gamepads.1.up", "gamepads.1.down", "gamepads.1.left", "gamepads.1.right", |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
470 "gamepads.1.a", "gamepads.1.b", "gamepads.1.c", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
471 "gamepads.1.x", "gamepads.1.y", "gamepads.1.z", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
472 "gamepads.1.start", "gamepads.1.mode" |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
473 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
474 static const char *controller2_binds[] = { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
475 "gamepads.2.up", "gamepads.2.down", "gamepads.2.left", "gamepads.2.right", |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
476 "gamepads.2.a", "gamepads.2.b", "gamepads.2.c", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
477 "gamepads.2.x", "gamepads.2.y", "gamepads.2.z", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
478 "gamepads.2.start", "gamepads.2.mode" |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
479 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
480 static const char *general_binds[] = { |
2306
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
481 "ui.menu", "ui.save_state", "ui.load_state", "ui.toggle_fullscreen", "ui.soft_reset", "ui.reload", |
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
482 "ui.screenshot", "ui.vgm_log", "ui.sms_pause", "ui.toggle_keyboard_captured", "ui.release_mouse", "ui.exit" |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
483 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
484 static const char *general_names[] = { |
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
485 "Show Menu", "Quick Save", "Quick Load", "Toggle Fullscreen", "Soft Reset", "Reload Media", |
2306
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
486 "Internal Screenshot", "Toggle VGM Log", "SMS Pause", "Capture Keyboard", "Release Mouse", "Exit" |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
487 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
488 static const char *speed_binds[] = { |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
489 "ui.next_speed", "ui.prev_speed", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
490 "ui.set_speed.0", "ui.set_speed.1", "ui.set_speed.2" ,"ui.set_speed.3", "ui.set_speed.4", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
491 "ui.set_speed.5", "ui.set_speed.6", "ui.set_speed.7" ,"ui.set_speed.8", "ui.set_speed.9", |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
492 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
493 static const char *speed_names[] = { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
494 "Next", "Previous", |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
495 "Default Speed", "Set Speed 1", "Set Speed 2", "Set Speed 3", "Set Speed 4", |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
496 "Set Speed 5", "Set Speed 6", "Set Speed 7", "Set Speed 8", "Set Speed 9" |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
497 }; |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
498 static const char *debug_binds[] = { |
1660
c6cc2dae262f
Updated binding UI to reflect new VDP debug options
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1658
diff
changeset
|
499 "ui.enter_debugger", "ui.plane_debug", "ui.vram_debug", "ui.cram_debug", |
c6cc2dae262f
Updated binding UI to reflect new VDP debug options
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1658
diff
changeset
|
500 "ui.compositing_debug", "ui.vdp_debug_mode" |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
501 }; |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
502 const char *debug_names[] = { |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
503 "CPU Debugger", "Plane Debugger", "VRAM Debugger", "CRAM Debugger", |
1660
c6cc2dae262f
Updated binding UI to reflect new VDP debug options
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1658
diff
changeset
|
504 "Layer Debugger", "Cycle Mode/Pal" |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
505 }; |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
506 const uint32_t NUM_C1_BINDS = sizeof(controller1_binds)/sizeof(*controller1_binds); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
507 const uint32_t NUM_C2_BINDS = sizeof(controller2_binds)/sizeof(*controller2_binds); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
508 const uint32_t NUM_SPEED_BINDS = sizeof(speed_binds)/sizeof(*speed_binds); |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
509 const uint32_t NUM_GEN_BINDS = sizeof(general_binds)/sizeof(*general_binds); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
510 const uint32_t NUM_DBG_BINDS = sizeof(debug_binds)/sizeof(*debug_binds); |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
511 static tern_node *binding_lookup; |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
512 if (!binding_lookup) { |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
513 tern_node *bindings = tern_find_path(config, "bindings\0keys\0", TVAL_NODE).ptrval; |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
514 if (bindings) { |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
515 tern_foreach(bindings, binding_loop, &binding_lookup); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
516 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
517 } |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
518 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
519 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
520 if (nk_begin(context, "Keyboard Bindings", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
521 binding_group(context, "Controller 1", controller1_binds, NULL, NUM_C1_BINDS, binding_lookup); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
522 binding_group(context, "Controller 2", controller2_binds, NULL, NUM_C2_BINDS, binding_lookup); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
523 binding_group(context, "General", general_binds, general_names, NUM_GEN_BINDS, binding_lookup); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
524 binding_group(context, "Speed Control", speed_binds, speed_names, NUM_SPEED_BINDS, binding_lookup); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
525 binding_group(context, "Debug", debug_binds, debug_names, NUM_DBG_BINDS, binding_lookup); |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
526 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.1333, (render_width() - 80) / 2, 1); |
1545
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
527 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
528 pop_view(); |
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
529 } |
1520
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
530 nk_end(context); |
cb3c6395b28c
Initial work on keyboard binding settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1501
diff
changeset
|
531 } |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
532 if (set_binding && nk_begin(context, "Set Binding", nk_rect(width/4, height/4, width/2/*width*3/4*/, height/2), NK_WINDOW_TITLE | NK_WINDOW_BORDER)) { |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
533 nk_layout_row_static(context, 30, width/2-30, 1); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
534 nk_label(context, "Press new key for", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
535 nk_label(context, set_label, NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
536 if (nk_button_label(context, "Cancel") && bind_click_release) { |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
537 free(set_label); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
538 set_binding = set_label = NULL; |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
539 } else if (keycode) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
540 char *name = get_key_name(keycode); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
541 if (name) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
542 uint32_t prefix_len = strlen("bindings") + strlen("keys") + 2; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
543 char * old = tern_find_ptr(binding_lookup, set_binding); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
544 if (old) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
545 uint32_t suffix_len = strlen(old) + 1; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
546 char *old_path = malloc(prefix_len + suffix_len + 1); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
547 memcpy(old_path, "bindings\0keys\0", prefix_len); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
548 memcpy(old_path + prefix_len, old, suffix_len); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
549 old_path[prefix_len + suffix_len] = 0; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
550 tern_val old_val; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
551 if (tern_delete_path(&config, old_path, &old_val) == TVAL_PTR) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
552 free(old_val.ptrval); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
553 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
554 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
555 uint32_t suffix_len = strlen(name) + 1; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
556 char *path = malloc(prefix_len + suffix_len + 1); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
557 memcpy(path, "bindings\0keys\0", prefix_len); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
558 memcpy(path + prefix_len, name, suffix_len); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
559 path[prefix_len + suffix_len] = 0; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
560 |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
561 config_dirty = 1; |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
562 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(set_binding)}, TVAL_PTR); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
563 free(path); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
564 free(name); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
565 tern_free(binding_lookup); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
566 binding_lookup = NULL; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
567 } |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
568 free(set_label); |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
569 set_binding = set_label = NULL; |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
570 } else if (!click) { |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
571 bind_click_release = 1; |
1521
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
572 } |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
573 nk_end(context); |
a51721408c15
More fleshed out keyboard bindings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1520
diff
changeset
|
574 } |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
575 } |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
576 |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
577 static int selected_controller; |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
578 static controller_info selected_controller_info; |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
579 //#define MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH 140 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
580 #define MAX_BIND_BOX_WIDTH 350 |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
581 |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
582 #define AXIS 0x40000000 |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
583 #define STICKDIR 0x30000000 |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
584 #define LEFTSTICK 0x10000000 |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
585 #define RIGHTSTICK 0x20000000 |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
586 enum { |
2310
b0ec82a59472
Fix analog stick directions being messed up in controller binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2308
diff
changeset
|
587 DOWN, UP,RIGHT,LEFT,NUM_AXIS_DIRS |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
588 }; |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
589 |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
590 static char * config_ps_names[] = { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
591 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A] = "cross", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
592 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B] = "circle", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
593 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_X] = "square", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
594 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_Y] = "triangle", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
595 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_BACK] = "share", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
596 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_START] = "options", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
597 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER] = "l1", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
598 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER] = "r1", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
599 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSTICK] = "l3", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
600 [SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSTICK] = "r3", |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
601 }; |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
602 |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
603 typedef struct { |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
604 const char *button_binds[SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX]; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
605 const char *left_stick[NUM_AXIS_DIRS]; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
606 const char *right_stick[NUM_AXIS_DIRS]; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
607 const char *triggers[2]; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
608 } pad_bind_config; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
609 |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
610 static const char **current_bind_dest; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
611 |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
612 const char *translate_binding_option(const char *option) |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
613 { |
1625
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
614 static tern_node *conf_names; |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
615 if (!conf_names) { |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
616 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.up", "Pad Up"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
617 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.down", "Pad Down"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
618 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.left", "Pad Left"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
619 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.right", "Pad Right"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
620 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.a", "Pad A"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
621 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.b", "Pad B"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
622 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.c", "Pad C"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
623 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.x", "Pad X"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
624 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.y", "Pad Y"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
625 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.z", "Pad Z"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
626 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.start", "Pad Start"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
627 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "gamepads.n.mode", "Pad Mode"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
628 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.release_mouse", "Release Mouse"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
629 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.vdp_debug_mode", "VDP Debug Mode"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
630 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.vdp_debug_pal", "VDP Debug Palette"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
631 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.enter_debugger", "Enter CPU Debugger"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
632 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.screenshot", "Take Screenshot"); |
1910
ee178f08611b
Expose vgm toggle keybind in settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1900
diff
changeset
|
633 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.vgm_log", "Toggle VGM Log"); |
2306
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
634 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.menu", "Show Menu"); |
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
635 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.exit", "Exit"); |
1625
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
636 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.save_state", "Quick Save"); |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
637 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.load_state", "Quick Load"); |
1625
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
638 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.0", "Set Speed 0"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
639 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.1", "Set Speed 1"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
640 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.2", "Set Speed 2"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
641 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.3", "Set Speed 3"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
642 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.4", "Set Speed 4"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
643 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.5", "Set Speed 5"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
644 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.6", "Set Speed 6"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
645 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.7", "Set Speed 7"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
646 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.8", "Set Speed 8"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
647 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.set_speed.9", "Set Speed 9"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
648 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.next_speed", "Next Speed"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
649 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.prev_speed", "Prev. Speed"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
650 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.toggle_fullscreen", "Toggle Fullscreen"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
651 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.soft_reset", "Soft Reset"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
652 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.reload", "Reload ROM"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
653 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.sms_pause", "SMS Pause"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
654 conf_names = tern_insert_ptr(conf_names, "ui.toggle_keyboard_captured", "Toggle Keyboard Capture"); |
6130e1e72151
Show user friendly names for binding options in controller bind config
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1624
diff
changeset
|
655 } |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
656 return tern_find_ptr_default(conf_names, option, (void *)option); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
657 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
658 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
659 static uint8_t controller_binding_changed; |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
660 static void bind_option_group(struct nk_context *context, char *name, const char **options, uint32_t num_options) |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
661 { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
662 float margin = context->style.font->height * 2; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
663 nk_layout_row_static(context, (context->style.font->height + 3) * ((num_options + 2) / 3) + context->style.font->height*2.1, render_width() - margin, 1); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
664 if (nk_group_begin(context, name, NK_WINDOW_TITLE|NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
665 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, (render_width() - margin - context->style.font->height) / 3, 3); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
666 for (int i = 0; i < num_options; i++) |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
667 { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
668 if (nk_button_label(context, translate_binding_option(options[i]))) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
669 *current_bind_dest = options[i]; |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
670 controller_binding_changed = 1; |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
671 pop_view(); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
672 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
673 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
674 nk_group_end(context); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
675 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
676 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
677 |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
678 static void view_button_binding(struct nk_context *context) |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
679 { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
680 static const char *pad_opts[] = { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
681 "gamepads.n.up", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
682 "gamepads.n.down", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
683 "gamepads.n.left", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
684 "gamepads.n.right", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
685 "gamepads.n.a", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
686 "gamepads.n.b", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
687 "gamepads.n.c", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
688 "gamepads.n.x", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
689 "gamepads.n.y", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
690 "gamepads.n.z", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
691 "gamepads.n.start", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
692 "gamepads.n.mode" |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
693 }; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
694 static const char *system_buttons[] = { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
695 "ui.soft_reset", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
696 "ui.reload", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
697 "ui.sms_pause" |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
698 }; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
699 static const char *emu_control[] = { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
700 "ui.save_state", |
2162
1270fe86eb89
Add Quick Load binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2156
diff
changeset
|
701 "ui.load_state", |
2306
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
702 "ui.menu", |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
703 "ui.toggle_fullscreen", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
704 "ui.screenshot", |
2306
62f316b76e9a
Migrate ui.exit to ui.menu and create a new ui.exit for quitting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2299
diff
changeset
|
705 "ui.exit", |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
706 "ui.release_mouse", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
707 "ui.toggle_keyboard_captured" |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
708 }; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
709 static const char *debugger[] = { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
710 "ui.vdp_debug_mode", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
711 "ui.vdp_debug_pal", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
712 "ui.enter_debugger" |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
713 }; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
714 static const char *speeds[] = { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
715 "ui.next_speed", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
716 "ui.prev_speed", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
717 "ui.set_speed.0", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
718 "ui.set_speed.1", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
719 "ui.set_speed.2", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
720 "ui.set_speed.3", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
721 "ui.set_speed.4", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
722 "ui.set_speed.5", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
723 "ui.set_speed.6", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
724 "ui.set_speed.7", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
725 "ui.set_speed.8", |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
726 "ui.set_speed.9" |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
727 }; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
728 |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
729 if (nk_begin(context, "Button Binding", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
730 bind_option_group(context, "Controller Buttons", pad_opts, sizeof(pad_opts)/sizeof(*pad_opts)); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
731 bind_option_group(context, "System Buttons", system_buttons, sizeof(system_buttons)/sizeof(*system_buttons)); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
732 bind_option_group(context, "Emulator Control", emu_control, sizeof(emu_control)/sizeof(*emu_control)); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
733 bind_option_group(context, "Debugging", debugger, sizeof(debugger)/sizeof(*debugger)); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
734 bind_option_group(context, "Speed Control", speeds, sizeof(speeds)/sizeof(*speeds)); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
735 |
2311
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
736 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, (render_width() - 80)/4, 2); |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
737 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
738 pop_view(); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
739 } |
2311
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
740 if (nk_button_label(context, "Clear")) { |
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
741 *current_bind_dest = NULL; |
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
742 controller_binding_changed = 1; |
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
743 pop_view(); |
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
744 } |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
745 nk_end(context); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
746 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
747 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
748 |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
749 static void binding_box(struct nk_context *context, pad_bind_config *bindings, char *name, float x, float y, float width, int num_binds, int *binds) |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
750 { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
751 const struct nk_user_font *font = context->style.font; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
752 float row_height = font->height * 2; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
753 |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
754 char const **labels = calloc(sizeof(char *), num_binds); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
755 char const ***conf_vals = calloc(sizeof(char *), num_binds); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
756 float max_width = 0.0f; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
757 |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
758 int skipped = 0; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
759 for (int i = 0; i < num_binds; i++) |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
760 { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
761 if (binds[i] & AXIS) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
762 labels[i] = get_axis_label(&selected_controller_info, binds[i] & ~AXIS); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
763 conf_vals[i] = &bindings->triggers[(binds[i] & ~AXIS) - SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT]; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
764 } else if (binds[i] & STICKDIR) { |
2311
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
765 static char const * dirs[] = {"Down", "Up", "Right", "Left"}; |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
766 labels[i] = dirs[binds[i] & 3]; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
767 conf_vals[i] = &(binds[i] & LEFTSTICK ? bindings->left_stick : bindings->right_stick)[binds[i] & 3]; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
768 } else { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
769 labels[i] = get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, binds[i]); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
770 conf_vals[i] = &bindings->button_binds[binds[i]]; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
771 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
772 if (!labels[i]) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
773 skipped++; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
774 continue; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
775 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
776 float lb_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, labels[i], strlen(labels[i])); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
777 max_width = max_width < lb_width ? lb_width : max_width; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
778 } |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
779 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(x, y, width, (num_binds - skipped) * (row_height + 4) + 4)); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
780 nk_group_begin(context, name, NK_WINDOW_BORDER | NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
781 |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
782 float widths[] = {max_width + 3, width - (max_width + 6)}; |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
783 nk_layout_row(context, NK_STATIC, row_height, 2, widths); |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
784 for (int i = 0; i < num_binds; i++) |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
785 { |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
786 if (!labels[i]) { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
787 continue; |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
788 } |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
789 nk_label(context, labels[i], NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
1626
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
790 const char *name = *conf_vals[i] ? translate_binding_option(*conf_vals[i]) : "None"; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
791 if (nk_button_label(context, name)) { |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
792 current_bind_dest = conf_vals[i]; |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
793 push_view(view_button_binding); |
2c3536082c0f
Add new view for selecting a new binding for a gamepad button
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1625
diff
changeset
|
794 } |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
795 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
796 free(labels); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
797 free(conf_vals); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
798 nk_group_end(context); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
799 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
800 |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
801 static void button_iter(char *key, tern_val val, uint8_t valtype, void *data) |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
802 { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
803 pad_bind_config *bindings = data; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
804 if (valtype != TVAL_PTR) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
805 return; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
806 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
807 int button = render_lookup_button(key); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
808 if (button != SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_INVALID) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
809 bindings->button_binds[button] = val.ptrval; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
810 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
811 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
812 |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
813 static void axis_iter(char *key, tern_val val, uint8_t valtype, void *data) |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
814 { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
815 pad_bind_config *bindings = data; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
816 if (valtype != TVAL_PTR) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
817 return; |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
818 } |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
819 int axis; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
820 uint8_t is_negative = 0; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
821 char *period = strchr(key, '.'); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
822 if (period) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
823 char *tmp = malloc(period-key + 1); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
824 memcpy(tmp, key, period-key); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
825 tmp[period-key] = 0; |
1624
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
826 axis = render_lookup_axis(tmp); |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
827 free(tmp); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
828 is_negative = strcmp(period+1, "negative") == 0; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
829 } else { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
830 axis = render_lookup_axis(key); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
831 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
832 switch (axis) |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
833 { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
834 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTX: |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
835 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTY: |
2311
07aeea6cb068
Fix analog stick UI for real. Allow clearing a controller binding
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2310
diff
changeset
|
836 bindings->left_stick[(SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTY - axis) * 2 + is_negative] = val.ptrval; |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
837 break; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
838 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_RIGHTX: |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
839 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_RIGHTY: |
2313
ef5dc4d02d27
Fix goof in right analog stick mapping UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2312
diff
changeset
|
840 bindings->right_stick[(SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_RIGHTY - axis) * 2 + is_negative] = val.ptrval; |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
841 break; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
842 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT: |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
843 case SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT: |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
844 bindings->triggers[axis-SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT] = val.ptrval; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
845 break; |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
846 } |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
847 } |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
848 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
849 enum { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
850 SIMILAR_CONTROLLERS, |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
851 IDENTICAL_CONTROLLERS, |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
852 BY_INDEX, |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
853 DEFAULT, |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
854 NUM_DEST_TYPES |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
855 }; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
856 |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
857 //it would be cleaner to generate this algorithmically for 4th and up, |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
858 //but BlastEm only supports 8 controllers currently so it's not worth the effort |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
859 static const char *by_index_names[] = { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
860 "Use for 1st controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
861 "Use for 2nd controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
862 "Use for 3rd controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
863 "Use for 4th controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
864 "Use for 5th controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
865 "Use for 6th controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
866 "Use for 7th controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
867 "Use for 8th controller", |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
868 }; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
869 |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
870 static void save_stick_binds(char *axes_key, size_t axes_key_size, const char **bindings, char *prefix) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
871 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
872 for (int i = 0; i < NUM_AXIS_DIRS; i++) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
873 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
874 char axis = (i / 2) ? 'x' : 'y'; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
875 char *suffix = (i % 2) ? ".negative" : ".positive"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
876 size_t prefix_len = strlen(prefix), suffix_len = strlen(suffix); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
877 size_t full_key_size = axes_key_size + prefix_len + 1 + suffix_len + 2; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
878 char *full_key = malloc(full_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
879 memcpy(full_key, axes_key, axes_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
880 memcpy(full_key + axes_key_size, prefix, prefix_len); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
881 full_key[axes_key_size+prefix_len] = axis; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
882 memcpy(full_key + axes_key_size + prefix_len + 1, suffix, suffix_len +1); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
883 full_key[axes_key_size + prefix_len + 1 + suffix_len + 1] = 0; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
884 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
885 if (bindings[i]) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
886 tern_insert_path(config, full_key, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(bindings[i])}, TVAL_PTR); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
887 } else { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
888 tern_val prev_val; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
889 uint8_t prev_type = tern_delete_path(&config, full_key, &prev_val); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
890 if (prev_type == TVAL_PTR) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
891 free(prev_val.ptrval); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
892 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
893 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
894 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
895 free(full_key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
896 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
897 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
898 |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
899 static pad_bind_config *bindings; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
900 static void handle_dest_clicked(uint32_t dest) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
901 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
902 char key_buf[12]; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
903 char *key; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
904 switch (dest) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
905 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
906 case SIMILAR_CONTROLLERS: |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
907 key = make_controller_type_key(&selected_controller_info); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
908 break; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
909 case IDENTICAL_CONTROLLERS: |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
910 key = render_joystick_type_id(selected_controller); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
911 break; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
912 case BY_INDEX: |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
913 snprintf(key_buf, sizeof(key_buf), "%d", selected_controller); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
914 key = key_buf; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
915 break; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
916 default: |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
917 key = "default"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
918 break; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
919 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
920 static const char base_path[] = "bindings\0pads"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
921 size_t pad_key_size = sizeof(base_path) + strlen(key) + 1; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
922 char *pad_key = malloc(pad_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
923 memcpy(pad_key, base_path, sizeof(base_path)); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
924 strcpy(pad_key + sizeof(base_path), key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
925 static const char dpad_base[] = "dpads\0""0"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
926 size_t dpad_key_size = pad_key_size + sizeof(dpad_base); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
927 char *dpad_key = malloc(dpad_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
928 memcpy(dpad_key, pad_key, pad_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
929 memcpy(dpad_key + pad_key_size, dpad_base, sizeof(dpad_base)); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
930 static const char button_base[] = "buttons"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
931 size_t button_key_size = pad_key_size + sizeof(button_base); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
932 char *button_key = malloc(button_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
933 memcpy(button_key, pad_key, pad_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
934 memcpy(button_key + pad_key_size, button_base, sizeof(button_base)); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
935 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
936 char *final_key; |
2307
a8080240cb92
Fix silly bug I introduced when trying to fix the problem from the SDL2 upgrade
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2306
diff
changeset
|
937 for (int i = 0; i < SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX; i++) |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
938 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
939 char *base; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
940 const char *suffix; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
941 size_t base_key_len; |
2299
a1c9edf44c7e
Fix a place I missed a problem from the SDL2 upgrade
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2294
diff
changeset
|
942 if ( i < SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP || i > SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_RIGHT) { |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
943 suffix = SDL_GameControllerGetStringForButton(i); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
944 base_key_len = button_key_size; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
945 base = button_key; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
946 } else { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
947 static const char *dir_keys[] = {"up", "down", "left", "right"}; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
948 suffix = dir_keys[i - SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP]; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
949 base = dpad_key; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
950 base_key_len = dpad_key_size; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
951 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
952 size_t suffix_len = strlen(suffix); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
953 final_key = malloc(base_key_len + suffix_len + 2); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
954 memcpy(final_key, base, base_key_len); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
955 memcpy(final_key + base_key_len, suffix, suffix_len + 1); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
956 final_key[base_key_len + suffix_len + 1] = 0; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
957 if (bindings->button_binds[i]) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
958 tern_insert_path(config, final_key, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(bindings->button_binds[i])}, TVAL_PTR); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
959 } else { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
960 tern_val prev_val; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
961 uint8_t prev_type = tern_delete_path(&config, final_key, &prev_val); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
962 if (prev_type == TVAL_PTR) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
963 free(prev_val.ptrval); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
964 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
965 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
966 free(final_key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
967 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
968 free(button_key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
969 free(dpad_key); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
970 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
971 static const char axes_base[] = "axes"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
972 size_t axes_key_size = pad_key_size + sizeof(axes_base); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
973 char *axes_key = malloc(axes_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
974 memcpy(axes_key, pad_key, pad_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
975 memcpy(axes_key + pad_key_size, axes_base, sizeof(axes_base)); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
976 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
977 save_stick_binds(axes_key, axes_key_size,bindings->left_stick, "left"); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
978 save_stick_binds(axes_key, axes_key_size,bindings->right_stick, "right"); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
979 for (int i = SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT; i < SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_MAX; i++) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
980 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
981 const char *suffix = SDL_GameControllerGetStringForAxis(i); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
982 size_t suffix_len = strlen(suffix); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
983 final_key = malloc(axes_key_size + suffix_len + 2); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
984 memcpy(final_key, axes_key, axes_key_size); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
985 memcpy(final_key + axes_key_size, suffix, suffix_len + 1); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
986 final_key[axes_key_size + suffix_len + 1] = 0; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
987 if (bindings->triggers[i - SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT]) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
988 tern_insert_path(config, final_key, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(bindings->triggers[i - SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT])}, TVAL_PTR); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
989 } else { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
990 tern_val prev_val; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
991 uint8_t prev_type = tern_delete_path(&config, final_key, &prev_val); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
992 if (prev_type == TVAL_PTR) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
993 free(prev_val.ptrval); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
994 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
995 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
996 free(final_key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
997 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
998 free(axes_key); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
999 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1000 free(pad_key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1001 if (dest == SIMILAR_CONTROLLERS) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1002 free(key); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1003 } |
2312
3f2ecd156453
Fix use after free when re-entering controller binding UI after saving bindings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2311
diff
changeset
|
1004 free(bindings); |
3f2ecd156453
Fix use after free when re-entering controller binding UI after saving bindings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2311
diff
changeset
|
1005 bindings = NULL; |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1006 pop_view(); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1007 config_dirty = 1; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1008 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1009 |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1010 void view_select_binding_dest(struct nk_context *context) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1011 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1012 static menu_item options[NUM_DEST_TYPES]; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1013 options[IDENTICAL_CONTROLLERS].title = "Use for identical controllers"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1014 options[DEFAULT].title = "Use as default"; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1015 options[BY_INDEX].title = by_index_names[selected_controller]; |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1016 options[SIMILAR_CONTROLLERS].title = make_human_readable_type_name(&selected_controller_info); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1017 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1018 if (nk_begin(context, "Select Binding Dest", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1019 menu(context, NUM_DEST_TYPES, options, handle_dest_clicked); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1020 nk_end(context); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1021 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1022 free((char *)options[SIMILAR_CONTROLLERS].title); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1023 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1024 |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1025 static ui_image *select_best_image(controller_info *info) |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1026 { |
2020
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1027 if (info->variant != VARIANT_NORMAL || info->type == TYPE_SEGA) { |
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1028 if (info->type == TYPE_PSX) { |
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1029 return controller_ps4_6b; |
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1030 } else { |
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1031 return controller_gen_6b; |
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
1032 } |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1033 } else if (info->type == TYPE_PSX) { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1034 return controller_ps4; |
2003
4c418ee9a9d8
Added Wii U controller image
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1980
diff
changeset
|
1035 } else if (info->type == TYPE_NINTENDO) { |
4c418ee9a9d8
Added Wii U controller image
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1980
diff
changeset
|
1036 return controller_wiiu; |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1037 } else { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1038 return controller_360; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1039 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1040 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1041 |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1042 void view_controller_bindings(struct nk_context *context) |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
1043 { |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1044 if (nk_begin(context, "Controller Bindings", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1045 if (!bindings) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1046 bindings = calloc(1, sizeof(*bindings)); |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1047 tern_node *pad = get_binding_node_for_pad(selected_controller, &selected_controller_info); |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1048 if (pad) { |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1049 tern_foreach(tern_find_node(pad, "buttons"), button_iter, bindings); |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1050 tern_foreach(tern_find_node(pad, "axes"), axis_iter, bindings); |
1624
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1051 tern_node *dpad = tern_find_path(pad, "dpads\0" "0\0", TVAL_NODE).ptrval; |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1052 const char *dir_keys[] = {"up", "down", "right", "left"}; |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1053 const int button_idx[] = {SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_DOWN, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_RIGHT, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_LEFT}; |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1054 for (int i = 0; i < NUM_AXIS_DIRS; i++) |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1055 { |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1056 bindings->button_binds[button_idx[i]] = tern_find_ptr(dpad, dir_keys[i]); |
7bbe0bfedb58
Handle looking up dpad config in binding UI. Fix left/right stick config display in binding UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1623
diff
changeset
|
1057 } |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1058 } |
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1059 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1060 |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1061 float orig_height = def_font->handle.height; |
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1062 def_font->handle.height *= 0.5f; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1063 |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1064 uint32_t avail_height = render_height() - 2 * orig_height; |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1065 float desired_width = render_width() * 0.5f, desired_height = avail_height * 0.5f; |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1066 ui_image *controller_image = select_best_image(&selected_controller_info); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1067 |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1068 float controller_ratio = (float)controller_image->width / (float)controller_image->height; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1069 |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1070 const struct nk_user_font *font = context->style.font; |
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1071 int MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Right", strlen("Right")) |
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1072 + def_font->handle.width(font->userdata, font->height, "Internal Screenshot", strlen("Internal Screenshot")); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1073 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1074 if (render_width() - desired_width < 2.5f*MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1075 desired_width = render_width() - 2.5f*MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1076 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1077 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1078 if (desired_width / desired_height > controller_ratio) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1079 desired_width = desired_height * controller_ratio; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1080 } else { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1081 desired_height = desired_width / controller_ratio; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1082 } |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1083 float img_left = render_width() / 2.0f - desired_width / 2.0f; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1084 float img_top = avail_height / 2.0f - desired_height / 2.0f; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1085 float img_right = img_left + desired_width; |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1086 float img_bot = img_top + desired_height; |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1087 nk_layout_space_begin(context, NK_STATIC, avail_height, INT_MAX); |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1088 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(img_left, img_top, desired_width, desired_height)); |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1089 nk_image(context, controller_image->ui); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1090 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1091 float bind_box_width = (render_width() - img_right) * 0.8f; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1092 if (bind_box_width < MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1093 bind_box_width = render_width() - img_right; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1094 if (bind_box_width > MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1095 bind_box_width = MIN_BIND_BOX_WIDTH; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1096 } |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1097 } else if (bind_box_width > MAX_BIND_BOX_WIDTH) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1098 bind_box_width = MAX_BIND_BOX_WIDTH; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1099 } |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1100 float bind_box_left; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1101 if (bind_box_width >= (render_width() - img_right)) { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1102 bind_box_left = img_right; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1103 } else { |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1104 bind_box_left = img_right + (render_width() - img_right) / 2.0f - bind_box_width / 2.0f; |
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1105 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1106 |
1647
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1107 if (selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_NORMAL) { |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1108 binding_box(context, bindings, "Action Buttons", bind_box_left, img_top, bind_box_width, 4, (int[]){ |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1109 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1110 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1111 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_X, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1112 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_Y |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1113 }); |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1114 } else { |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1115 binding_box(context, bindings, "Action Buttons", bind_box_left, img_top, bind_box_width, 6, (int[]){ |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1116 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1117 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1118 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_RIGHT ? AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT : SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1119 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_X, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1120 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_Y, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1121 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_RIGHT ? SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER : SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1122 }); |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1123 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1124 |
1816
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1125 if (selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_NORMAL) { |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1126 binding_box(context, bindings, "Right Shoulder", bind_box_left, font->height/2, bind_box_width, 2, (int[]){ |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1127 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER, |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1128 AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1129 }); |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1130 } else { |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1131 binding_box(context, bindings, "Right Shoulder", bind_box_left, font->height/2, bind_box_width, |
2219
ff700f50541c
Fix duplicated right trigger mapping button in bindings for 8-button Genesis style controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2202
diff
changeset
|
1132 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_RIGHT ? 2 : 1, |
1816
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1133 (int[]){ |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1134 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_RIGHT ? SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER : AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT, |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1135 AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1136 }); |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1137 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1138 |
1623
18a946ec74c8
Pull current controller config in binding UI from whatever the actual binding code would end up using
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1609
diff
changeset
|
1139 binding_box(context, bindings, "Misc Buttons", (render_width() - bind_box_width) / 2, font->height/2, bind_box_width, 3, (int[]){ |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1140 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_BACK, |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1141 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_GUIDE, |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1142 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_START |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1143 }); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1144 |
1647
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1145 if (selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_NORMAL) |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1146 { |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1147 binding_box(context, bindings, "Right Stick", img_right - desired_width/3, img_bot, bind_box_width, 5, (int[]){ |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1148 RIGHTSTICK | UP, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1149 RIGHTSTICK | DOWN, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1150 RIGHTSTICK | LEFT, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1151 RIGHTSTICK | RIGHT, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1152 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSTICK |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1153 }); |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1154 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1155 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1156 bind_box_left -= img_right; |
1647
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1157 float dpad_left, dpad_top; |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1158 if (selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_NORMAL) |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1159 { |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1160 binding_box(context, bindings, "Left Stick", bind_box_left, img_top, bind_box_width, 5, (int[]){ |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1161 LEFTSTICK | UP, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1162 LEFTSTICK | DOWN, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1163 LEFTSTICK | LEFT, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1164 LEFTSTICK | RIGHT, |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1165 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSTICK |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1166 }); |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1167 dpad_left = img_left - desired_width/6; |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1168 dpad_top = img_bot + font->height * 1.5; |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1169 } else { |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1170 dpad_left = bind_box_left; |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1171 dpad_top = img_top; |
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1172 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1173 |
1816
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1174 if (selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_NORMAL) { |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1175 binding_box(context, bindings, "Left Shoulder", bind_box_left, font->height/2, bind_box_width, 2, (int[]){ |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1176 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER, |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1177 AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1178 }); |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1179 } else { |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1180 binding_box(context, bindings, "Left Shoulder", bind_box_left, font->height/2, bind_box_width, |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1181 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_BUMPERS ? 1 : 2, |
1816
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1182 (int[]){ |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1183 selected_controller_info.variant == VARIANT_6B_RIGHT ? SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSTICK : AXIS | SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT, |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1184 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSTICK |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1185 }); |
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1186 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1187 |
1647
5a662692c215
Update binding UI for non-standard controller layouts
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1646
diff
changeset
|
1188 binding_box(context, bindings, "D-pad", dpad_left, dpad_top, bind_box_width, 4, (int[]){ |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1189 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP, |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1190 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_DOWN, |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1191 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_LEFT, |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1192 SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_RIGHT |
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1193 }); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1194 |
1571
3def7b216a5b
WIP controller binding view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1570
diff
changeset
|
1195 nk_layout_space_end(context); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1196 |
1572
5efeca06d942
Scale UI font size based on window size and start basing widget sizes based on font size
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1571
diff
changeset
|
1197 def_font->handle.height = orig_height; |
1598
5e2af89c3467
Made controller binding page more resolution independent. Added binding boxes for all buttons/axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1596
diff
changeset
|
1198 nk_layout_row_static(context, orig_height + 4, (render_width() - 2*orig_height) / 4, 1); |
1816
1db1510c7506
Fix bumper/trigger binding boxes for "normal" style conntrollers. Change label of "Back" button to "Save" when there are unsaved changes in controller binding
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1815
diff
changeset
|
1199 if (nk_button_label(context, controller_binding_changed ? "Save" : "Back")) { |
1545
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
1200 pop_view(); |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1201 if (controller_binding_changed) { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1202 push_view(view_select_binding_dest); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1203 } |
1545
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
1204 } |
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
1205 nk_end(context); |
3faf917bab56
Add back button to Key binding view and add a window and back button to empty controller view so you can always get back to the main menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1527
diff
changeset
|
1206 } |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
1207 } |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1208 |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1209 static int current_button; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1210 static int current_axis; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1211 static int button_pressed, last_button; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1212 static int hat_moved, hat_value, last_hat, last_hat_value; |
1804
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1213 static int axis_moved, axis_value, last_axis, last_axis_value; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1214 static char *mapping_string; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1215 static size_t mapping_pos; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1216 |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1217 static void start_mapping(void) |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1218 { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1219 const char *name; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1220 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = ','; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1221 if (current_button != SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX) { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1222 name = SDL_GameControllerGetStringForButton(current_button); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1223 } else { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1224 name = SDL_GameControllerGetStringForAxis(current_axis); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1225 } |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1226 size_t namesz = strlen(name); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1227 memcpy(mapping_string + mapping_pos, name, namesz); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1228 mapping_pos += namesz; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1229 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = ':'; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1230 } |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1231 |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1232 static uint8_t initial_controller_config; |
1605
f7b1d983d5c0
Bump up pause between mapping inputs
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1604
diff
changeset
|
1233 #define QUIET_FRAMES 9 |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1234 static void view_controller_mappings(struct nk_context *context) |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1235 { |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1236 char buffer[512]; |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1237 static int quiet, button_a = -1, button_a_axis = -1; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1238 uint8_t added_mapping = 0; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1239 if (nk_begin(context, "Controllers", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1240 |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1241 nk_layout_space_begin(context, NK_STATIC, render_height() - context->style.font->height, 3); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1242 |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1243 if (current_button < SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX) { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1244 snprintf(buffer, sizeof(buffer), "Press Button %s", get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, current_button)); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1245 } else { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1246 snprintf(buffer, sizeof(buffer), "Move Axis %s", get_axis_label(&selected_controller_info, current_axis)); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1247 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1248 |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1249 float height = context->style.font->height * 1.25; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1250 float top = render_height()/2 - 1.5 * height; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1251 float width = render_width() - context->style.font->height; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1252 |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1253 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(0, top, width, height)); |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1254 nk_label(context, buffer, NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1255 if (current_button > SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1256 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(0, top + height, width, height)); |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1257 nk_label(context, "OR", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1258 |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1259 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(0, top + 2.0 * height, width, height)); |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1260 snprintf(buffer, sizeof(buffer), "Press Button %s to skip", get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A)); |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1261 nk_label(context, buffer, NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1262 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1263 |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1264 nk_layout_space_end(context); |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1265 if (quiet) { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1266 --quiet; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1267 } else { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1268 if (button_pressed >= 0 && button_pressed != last_button) { |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1269 if (current_button <= SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B || button_pressed != button_a) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1270 start_mapping(); |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1271 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = 'b'; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1272 if (button_pressed > 9) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1273 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + button_pressed / 10; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1274 } |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1275 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + button_pressed % 10; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1276 last_button = button_pressed; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1277 if (current_button == SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1278 button_a = button_pressed; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1279 } |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1280 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1281 added_mapping = 1; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1282 } else if (hat_moved >= 0 && hat_value && (hat_moved != last_hat || hat_value != last_hat_value)) { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1283 start_mapping(); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1284 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = 'h'; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1285 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + hat_moved; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1286 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '.'; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1287 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + hat_value; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1288 added_mapping = 1; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1289 |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1290 last_hat = hat_moved; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1291 last_hat_value = hat_value; |
1804
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1292 } else if (axis_moved >= 0 && abs(axis_value) > 1000 && ( |
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1293 axis_moved != last_axis || ( |
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1294 axis_value/abs(axis_value) != last_axis_value/abs(axis_value) && current_button >= SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP |
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1295 ) |
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1296 )) { |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1297 if (current_button <= SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_B || axis_moved != button_a_axis) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1298 start_mapping(); |
2022
380bc5d4a2cf
Fix format of axis mapping strings for axes that map to a d-pad
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2020
diff
changeset
|
1299 if (current_button >= SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_DPAD_UP) { |
380bc5d4a2cf
Fix format of axis mapping strings for axes that map to a d-pad
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2020
diff
changeset
|
1300 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = axis_value >= 0 ? '+' : '-'; |
380bc5d4a2cf
Fix format of axis mapping strings for axes that map to a d-pad
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2020
diff
changeset
|
1301 } |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1302 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = 'a'; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1303 if (axis_moved > 9) { |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1304 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + axis_moved / 10; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1305 } |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1306 mapping_string[mapping_pos++] = '0' + axis_moved % 10; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1307 last_axis = axis_moved; |
1804
34370330eaf3
Support controllers that have their dpad mapped to an axis
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1798
diff
changeset
|
1308 last_axis_value = axis_value; |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1309 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1310 added_mapping = 1; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1311 } |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1312 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1313 |
1806
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1314 while (added_mapping) { |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1315 quiet = QUIET_FRAMES; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1316 if (current_button < SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX) { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1317 current_button++; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1318 if (current_button == SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_MAX) { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1319 current_axis = 0; |
1806
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1320 if (get_axis_label(&selected_controller_info, current_axis)) { |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1321 added_mapping = 0; |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1322 } |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1323 } else if (get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, current_button)) { |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1324 added_mapping = 0; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1325 } |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1326 } else { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1327 current_axis++; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1328 if (current_axis == SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_MAX) { |
1666
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1329 button_a = -1; |
a1e0ed70ad82
Allow skipping buttons/axes in controller SDL2 mapping UI
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1664
diff
changeset
|
1330 button_a_axis = -1; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1331 mapping_string[mapping_pos] = 0; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1332 save_controller_mapping(selected_controller, mapping_string); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1333 free(mapping_string); |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1334 pop_view(); |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1335 if (initial_controller_config) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1336 push_view(view_controller_bindings); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1337 controller_binding_changed = 0; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1338 } |
1806
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1339 added_mapping = 0; |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1340 } else if (get_axis_label(&selected_controller_info, current_axis)) { |
396369ab481a
Skip buttons or axes in the mapping UI that have no label for the selected controller type
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1804
diff
changeset
|
1341 added_mapping = 0; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1342 } |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1343 } |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1344 } |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1345 button_pressed = -1; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1346 hat_moved = -1; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
1347 axis_moved = -1; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1348 nk_end(context); |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1349 } |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1350 } |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
1351 |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1352 static void show_mapping_view(void) |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1353 { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1354 current_button = SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_A; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1355 button_pressed = -1; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1356 last_button = -1; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1357 last_hat = -1; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1358 axis_moved = -1; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1359 last_axis = -1; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1360 last_axis_value = 0; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1361 SDL_Joystick *joy = render_get_joystick(selected_controller); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1362 const char *name = SDL_JoystickName(joy); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1363 size_t namesz = strlen(name); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1364 mapping_string = malloc(512 + namesz); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1365 for (mapping_pos = 0; mapping_pos < namesz; mapping_pos++) |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1366 { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1367 char c = name[mapping_pos]; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1368 if (c == ',' || c == '\n' || c == '\r') { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1369 c = ' '; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1370 } |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1371 mapping_string[mapping_pos] = c; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1372 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1373 |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1374 push_view(view_controller_mappings); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1375 } |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1376 |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1377 static void view_controller_variant(struct nk_context *context) |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1378 { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1379 uint8_t selected = 0; |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1380 if (nk_begin(context, "Controller Type", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1381 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height*1.25, render_width() - context->style.font->height * 2, 1); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1382 nk_label(context, "", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1383 nk_label(context, "Select the layout that", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1384 nk_label(context, "best matches your controller", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1385 nk_label(context, "", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
2015
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1386 if (selected_controller_info.subtype == SUBTYPE_GENESIS) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1387 if (nk_button_label(context, "3 button")) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1388 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_3BUTTON; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1389 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1390 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1391 if (nk_button_label(context, "Standard 6 button")) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1392 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_6B_BUMPERS; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1393 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1394 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1395 if (nk_button_label(context, "6 button with 2 shoulder buttons")) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1396 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_8BUTTON; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1397 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1398 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1399 } else { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1400 if (nk_button_label(context, "4 face buttons")) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1401 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_NORMAL; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1402 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1403 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1404 char buffer[512]; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1405 snprintf(buffer, sizeof(buffer), "6 face buttons including %s and %s", |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1406 get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER), |
2015
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1407 get_axis_label(&selected_controller_info, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT) |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1408 ); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1409 if (nk_button_label(context, buffer)) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1410 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_6B_RIGHT; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1411 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1412 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1413 snprintf(buffer, sizeof(buffer), "6 face buttons including %s and %s", |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1414 get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_LEFTSHOULDER), |
2015
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1415 get_button_label(&selected_controller_info, SDL_CONTROLLER_BUTTON_RIGHTSHOULDER) |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1416 ); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1417 if (nk_button_label(context, buffer)) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1418 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_6B_BUMPERS; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1419 selected = 1; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1420 } |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1421 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1422 nk_end(context); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1423 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1424 if (selected) { |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1425 save_controller_info(selected_controller, &selected_controller_info); |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1426 pop_view(); |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1427 if (initial_controller_config) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1428 SDL_GameController *controller = render_get_controller(selected_controller); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1429 if (controller) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1430 push_view(view_controller_bindings); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1431 controller_binding_changed = 0; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1432 SDL_GameControllerClose(controller); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1433 } else { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1434 show_mapping_view(); |
1604
68b05322d971
Don't redundantly store controller GUID when saving a mapping. Remove illegal chars from controller name
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1602
diff
changeset
|
1435 } |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1436 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1437 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1438 } |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1439 |
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1440 static void controller_type_group(struct nk_context *context, char *name, int type_id, int first_subtype_id, const char **types, uint32_t num_types) |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1441 { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1442 nk_layout_row_static(context, (context->style.font->height + 3) * num_types + context->style.font->height, render_width() - 80, 1); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1443 if (nk_group_begin(context, name, NK_WINDOW_TITLE)) { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1444 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, render_width()/2 - 80, 2); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1445 for (int i = 0; i < num_types; i++) |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1446 { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1447 if (nk_button_label(context, types[i])) { |
1602
b452887f85b4
Basic UI for selecting layout variants + minor fix to SDL2 mapping generation UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1601
diff
changeset
|
1448 selected_controller_info.type = type_id; |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1449 selected_controller_info.subtype = first_subtype_id + i; |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1450 pop_view(); |
2015
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1451 if (selected_controller_info.subtype == SUBTYPE_SATURN) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1452 selected_controller_info.variant = VARIANT_6B_BUMPERS; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1453 save_controller_info(selected_controller, &selected_controller_info); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1454 if (initial_controller_config) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1455 SDL_GameController *controller = render_get_controller(selected_controller); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1456 if (controller) { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1457 push_view(view_controller_bindings); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1458 controller_binding_changed = 0; |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1459 SDL_GameControllerClose(controller); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1460 } else { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1461 show_mapping_view(); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1462 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1463 } |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1464 } else { |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1465 push_view(view_controller_variant); |
8a64d86cc362
Use different variants for Genesis controllers to better represent what types are out there
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2014
diff
changeset
|
1466 } |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1467 } |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1468 } |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1469 nk_group_end(context); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1470 } |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1471 } |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1472 |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1473 void view_controller_type(struct nk_context *context) |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1474 { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1475 if (nk_begin(context, "Controller Type", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1476 controller_type_group(context, "Xbox", TYPE_XBOX, SUBTYPE_XBOX, (const char *[]){ |
2220
dd9d43c67986
Add support for newer controller types. Fix crash caused by new controller button types introduced in 2.0.12 and support mapping them
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2219
diff
changeset
|
1477 "Original", "Xbox 360", "Xbox One/Series", "Xbox Elite" |
dd9d43c67986
Add support for newer controller types. Fix crash caused by new controller button types introduced in 2.0.12 and support mapping them
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2219
diff
changeset
|
1478 }, 4); |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1479 controller_type_group(context, "Playstation", TYPE_PSX, SUBTYPE_PS3, (const char *[]){ |
2220
dd9d43c67986
Add support for newer controller types. Fix crash caused by new controller button types introduced in 2.0.12 and support mapping them
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2219
diff
changeset
|
1480 "PS3", "PS4", "PS5" |
dd9d43c67986
Add support for newer controller types. Fix crash caused by new controller button types introduced in 2.0.12 and support mapping them
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2219
diff
changeset
|
1481 }, 3); |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1482 controller_type_group(context, "Sega", TYPE_SEGA, SUBTYPE_GENESIS, (const char *[]){ |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1483 "Genesis", "Saturn" |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1484 }, 2); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1485 controller_type_group(context, "Nintendo", TYPE_NINTENDO, SUBTYPE_WIIU, (const char *[]){ |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1486 "WiiU", "Switch" |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1487 }, 2); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1488 nk_end(context); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1489 } |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1490 } |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1491 static uint8_t stick_nav_disabled; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1492 static SDL_GameController *current_controller; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1493 static uint8_t deadzones_dirty; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1494 void stick_deadzone_widget(float left, float top, float size, SDL_GameControllerAxis x_axis) |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1495 { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1496 float crosshair_size = context->style.font->height; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1497 nk_stroke_rect(&context->current->buffer, nk_rect(left, top, size, size), context->style.window.rounding, context->style.window.border, nk_rgb(255, 255, 255)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1498 float deadzone_size = selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone * size / 65535.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1499 int16_t raw_x = SDL_GameControllerGetAxis(current_controller, x_axis); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1500 int16_t raw_y = SDL_GameControllerGetAxis(current_controller, x_axis + 1); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1501 if (raw_x > selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1502 float points[] = { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1503 left + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1504 left + size, top, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1505 left + size, top + size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1506 left + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1507 }; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1508 nk_fill_polygon(&context->current->buffer, points, sizeof(points)/(2 * sizeof(float)), context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1509 } else if (raw_x < -selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1510 float points[] = { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1511 left, top, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1512 left + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1513 left + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1514 left, top + size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1515 }; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1516 nk_fill_polygon(&context->current->buffer, points, sizeof(points)/(2 * sizeof(float)), context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1517 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1518 if (raw_y > selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1519 float points[] = { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1520 left, top + size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1521 left + size, top + size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1522 left + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1523 left + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1524 }; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1525 nk_fill_polygon(&context->current->buffer, points, sizeof(points)/(2 * sizeof(float)), context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1526 } else if (raw_y < -selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1527 float points[] = { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1528 left, top, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1529 left + size, top, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1530 left + size * 0.5f + deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1531 left + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, top + size * 0.5f - deadzone_size, |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1532 }; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1533 nk_fill_polygon(&context->current->buffer, points, sizeof(points)/(2 * sizeof(float)), context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1534 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1535 nk_stroke_rect(&context->current->buffer, nk_rect(left + 0.5f * size - deadzone_size, top + 0.5f * size - deadzone_size, 2 * deadzone_size, 2 * deadzone_size), context->style.window.rounding, 0.5f * context->style.window.border, nk_rgb(200, 200, 200)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1536 //nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(left, top, size, size)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1537 float x = raw_x * size / 65535.0f + size / 2.0f - crosshair_size / 2.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1538 float y = raw_y * size / 65535.0f + size / 2.0f - crosshair_size / 2.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1539 nk_draw_symbol(&context->current->buffer, NK_SYMBOL_X, nk_rect(left + x, top + y, crosshair_size, crosshair_size), nk_rgb(0, 0, 0), nk_rgb(255, 255, 255), 1, context->style.font); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1540 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1541 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1542 void trigger_deadzone_widget(float left, float top, float size, SDL_GameControllerAxis axis) |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1543 { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1544 float crosshair_size = context->style.font->height; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1545 nk_stroke_rect(&context->current->buffer, nk_rect(left, top, size, crosshair_size * 1.5f), context->style.window.rounding, context->style.window.border, nk_rgb(255, 255, 255)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1546 float deadzone_size = selected_controller_info.trigger_deadzone * size / 32767.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1547 int16_t raw = SDL_GameControllerGetAxis(current_controller, axis); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1548 if (raw < 0) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1549 raw = 0; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1550 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1551 if (raw > selected_controller_info.trigger_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1552 nk_fill_rect(&context->current->buffer, nk_rect(left + deadzone_size, top, size - deadzone_size, 1.5f * crosshair_size), context->style.window.rounding, context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1553 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1554 nk_stroke_line(&context->current->buffer, left + deadzone_size, top, left + deadzone_size, top + 1.5f * crosshair_size, 0.5f * context->style.window.border, nk_rgb(200, 200, 200)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1555 float x = raw * size / 32767.0f - crosshair_size / 2.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1556 nk_draw_symbol(&context->current->buffer, NK_SYMBOL_X, nk_rect(left + x, top + 0.25f * crosshair_size, crosshair_size, crosshair_size), nk_rgb(0, 0, 0), nk_rgb(255, 255, 255), 1, context->style.font); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1557 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1558 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1559 void view_deadzones(struct nk_context *context) |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1560 { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1561 if (nk_begin(context, "Deadzones", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1562 nk_layout_space_begin(context, NK_STATIC, render_height() - 3 * context->style.font->height, 4); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1563 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1564 float left = render_width() / 8.0f, top = render_height() / 8.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1565 float size = render_height() / 3.0f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1566 stick_deadzone_widget(left, top, size, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_LEFTX); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1567 stick_deadzone_widget(left + 1.25f * size, top, size, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_RIGHTX); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1568 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1569 top += size + context->style.font->height; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1570 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(left, top, size * 2, context->style.font->height)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1571 int val = selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1572 nk_property_int(context, "Stick Deadzone", 250, &val, 32000, 250, 1.0f); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1573 if (val != selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1574 selected_controller_info.stick_deadzone = val; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1575 deadzones_dirty = 1; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1576 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1577 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1578 top += 2.0f * context->style.font->height; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1579 trigger_deadzone_widget(left, top, size, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERLEFT); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1580 trigger_deadzone_widget(left + 1.25f * size, top, size, SDL_CONTROLLER_AXIS_TRIGGERRIGHT); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1581 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1582 top += context->style.font->height * 2.5f; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1583 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(left, top, size * 2, context->style.font->height)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1584 val = selected_controller_info.trigger_deadzone; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1585 nk_property_int(context, "Trigger Deadzone", 250, &val, 32000, 250, 1.0f); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1586 if (val != selected_controller_info.trigger_deadzone) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1587 selected_controller_info.trigger_deadzone = val; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1588 deadzones_dirty = 1; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1589 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1590 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1591 nk_layout_space_end(context); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1592 |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1593 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, (render_width() - 2 * context->style.font->height) / 2, 2); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1594 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1595 stick_nav_disabled = 0; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1596 if (current_controller) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1597 SDL_GameControllerClose(current_controller); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1598 current_controller = NULL; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1599 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1600 if (deadzones_dirty) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1601 save_controller_info(selected_controller, &selected_controller_info); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1602 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1603 pop_view(); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1604 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1605 nk_end(context); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1606 } |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1607 } |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1608 |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1609 void view_controllers(struct nk_context *context) |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1610 { |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1611 if (nk_begin(context, "Controllers", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), NK_WINDOW_NO_SCROLLBAR)) { |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1612 int height = (render_height() - 2*context->style.font->height) / 5; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1613 int inner_height = height - context->style.window.spacing.y; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1614 const struct nk_user_font *font = context->style.font; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1615 int bindings_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Bindings", strlen("Bindings")) + context->style.button.padding.x * 2; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1616 int remap_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Remap", strlen("Remap")) + context->style.button.padding.x * 2; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1617 int change_type_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Change Type", strlen("Change Type")) + context->style.button.padding.x * 2; |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1618 int deadzones_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Deadzones", strlen("Deadzones")) + context->style.button.padding.x * 2; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1619 int total = bindings_width + remap_width + change_type_width + deadzones_width; |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1620 float bindings_ratio = (float)bindings_width / total; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1621 float remap_ratio = (float)remap_width / total; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1622 float change_type_ratio = (float)change_type_width / total; |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1623 float deadzones_ratio = (float)deadzones_width / total; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1624 |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1625 |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1626 uint8_t found_controller = 0; |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1627 for (int i = 0; i < MAX_JOYSTICKS; i++) |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1628 { |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1629 SDL_Joystick *joy = render_get_joystick(i); |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1630 if (joy) { |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1631 found_controller = 1; |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1632 controller_info info = get_controller_info(i); |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1633 ui_image *controller_image = select_best_image(&info); |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1634 int image_width = inner_height * controller_image->width / controller_image->height; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1635 nk_layout_space_begin(context, NK_STATIC, height, INT_MAX); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1636 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(context->style.font->height / 2, 0, image_width, inner_height)); |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1637 if (info.type == TYPE_UNKNOWN || info.type == TYPE_GENERIC_MAPPING) { |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1638 nk_label(context, "?", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1639 } else { |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
1640 nk_image(context, controller_image->ui); |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1641 } |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1642 int button_start = image_width + context->style.font->height; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1643 int button_area_width = render_width() - image_width - 2 * context->style.font->height; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1644 |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1645 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, 0, button_area_width, inner_height/2)); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1646 nk_label(context, info.name, NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1647 const struct nk_user_font *font = context->style.font; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1648 if (info.type == TYPE_UNKNOWN || info.type == TYPE_GENERIC_MAPPING) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1649 int button_width = font->width(font->userdata, font->height, "Configure", strlen("Configure")); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1650 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, height/2, button_width, inner_height/2)); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1651 if (nk_button_label(context, "Configure")) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1652 selected_controller = i; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1653 selected_controller_info = info; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1654 initial_controller_config = 1; |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1655 push_view(view_controller_type); |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1656 } |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1657 } else { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1658 button_area_width -= 2 * context->style.window.spacing.x; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1659 bindings_width = bindings_ratio * button_area_width; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1660 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, height/2, bindings_width, inner_height/2)); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1661 if (nk_button_label(context, "Bindings")) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1662 selected_controller = i; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1663 selected_controller_info = info; |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1664 push_view(view_controller_bindings); |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
1665 controller_binding_changed = 0; |
1599
1fc61c844ec5
Allow selecting controller type when controllers have an SDL 2 mapping, but heuristics fail to idenify details
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1598
diff
changeset
|
1666 } |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1667 button_start += bindings_width + context->style.window.spacing.x; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1668 remap_width = remap_ratio * button_area_width; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1669 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, height/2, remap_width, inner_height/2)); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1670 if (nk_button_label(context, "Remap")) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1671 selected_controller = i; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1672 selected_controller_info = info; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1673 initial_controller_config = 0; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1674 show_mapping_view(); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1675 } |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1676 button_start += remap_width + context->style.window.spacing.x; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1677 change_type_width = change_type_ratio * button_area_width; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1678 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, height/2, change_type_width, inner_height/2)); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1679 if (nk_button_label(context, "Change Type")) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1680 selected_controller = i; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1681 selected_controller_info = info; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1682 initial_controller_config = 0; |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1683 push_view(view_controller_type); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1684 } |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1685 button_start += change_type_width + context->style.window.spacing.x; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1686 deadzones_width = deadzones_ratio * button_area_width; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1687 nk_layout_space_push(context, nk_rect(button_start, height/2, deadzones_width, inner_height/2)); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1688 if (nk_button_label(context, "Deadzones")) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1689 selected_controller = i; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1690 selected_controller_info = info; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1691 current_controller = render_get_controller(i); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1692 stick_nav_disabled = 1; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1693 deadzones_dirty = 0; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1694 push_view(view_deadzones); |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1695 } |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1696 } |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
1697 nk_layout_space_end(context); |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1698 } |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1699 } |
1859
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1700 if (!found_controller) { |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1701 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, render_width() - 2 * context->style.font->height, 1); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1702 nk_label(context, "No controllers detected", NK_TEXT_CENTERED); |
52f136052ab0
Allow changing SDL2 mapping and controller type after initial configuration
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1858
diff
changeset
|
1703 } |
1596
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1704 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, (render_width() - 2 * context->style.font->height) / 2, 2); |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1705 nk_label(context, "", NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1706 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1707 pop_view(); |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1708 } |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1709 nk_end(context); |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1710 } |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1711 } |
437e80a700aa
Initial heuristics for detecting controller types and showing different labels in UI. Modified controller settings view to first display a list of controllers, only showing mapping after selecting controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1593
diff
changeset
|
1712 |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1713 void settings_toggle(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *path, uint8_t def) |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1714 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1715 uint8_t curval = !strcmp("on", tern_find_path_default(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = def ? "on": "off"}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1716 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1717 uint8_t newval = nk_check_label(context, "", curval); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1718 if (newval != curval) { |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
1719 config_dirty = 1; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1720 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(newval ? "on" : "off")}, TVAL_PTR); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1721 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1722 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1723 |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1724 void settings_int_input(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *path, char *def) |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1725 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1726 char buffer[12]; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1727 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1728 uint32_t curval; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1729 char *curstr = tern_find_path_default(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = def}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1730 uint32_t len = strlen(curstr); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1731 if (len > 11) { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1732 len = 11; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1733 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1734 memcpy(buffer, curstr, len); |
1593
24508cb54f87
Fix a number of other memory errors (mostly leaks again) identified by valgrind
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1581
diff
changeset
|
1735 memset(buffer+len, 0, sizeof(buffer)-len); |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1736 nk_edit_string(context, NK_EDIT_SIMPLE, buffer, &len, sizeof(buffer)-1, nk_filter_decimal); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1737 buffer[len] = 0; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1738 if (strcmp(buffer, curstr)) { |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
1739 config_dirty = 1; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1740 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(buffer)}, TVAL_PTR); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1741 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1742 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1743 |
1853
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1744 void settings_string(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *path, char *def) |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1745 { |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1746 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1747 char *curstr = tern_find_path_default(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = def}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1748 uint32_t len = strlen(curstr); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1749 uint32_t buffer_len = len > 100 ? len + 1 : 101; |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1750 char *buffer = malloc(buffer_len); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1751 memcpy(buffer, curstr, len); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1752 memset(buffer+len, 0, buffer_len-len); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1753 nk_edit_string(context, NK_EDIT_SIMPLE, buffer, &len, buffer_len-1, nk_filter_default); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1754 buffer[len] = 0; |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1755 if (strcmp(buffer, curstr)) { |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1756 config_dirty = 1; |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1757 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(buffer)}, TVAL_PTR); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1758 } |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1759 free(buffer); |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1760 } |
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
1761 |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1762 void settings_path(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *path, char *def, const char **exts, uint32_t num_exts) |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1763 { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1764 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1765 char *curstr = tern_find_path_default(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = def}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1766 uint32_t len = strlen(curstr); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1767 uint32_t buffer_len = len > 100 ? len + 1 : 101; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1768 char *buffer = malloc(buffer_len); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1769 memcpy(buffer, curstr, len); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1770 memset(buffer+len, 0, buffer_len-len); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1771 nk_edit_string(context, NK_EDIT_SIMPLE, buffer, &len, buffer_len-1, nk_filter_default); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1772 buffer[len] = 0; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1773 if (strcmp(buffer, curstr)) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1774 config_dirty = 1; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1775 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(buffer)}, TVAL_PTR); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1776 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1777 |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1778 nk_spacing(context, 1); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1779 if (nk_button_label(context, "Browse")) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1780 browser_label = label; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1781 browser_setting_path = path; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1782 browser_ext_list = exts; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1783 browser_num_exts = num_exts; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1784 if (is_absolute_path(buffer)) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1785 browser_cur_path = path_dirname(buffer); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1786 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1787 push_view(view_file_settings); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1788 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1789 free(buffer); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1790 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
1791 |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1792 void settings_int_property(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *name, char *path, int def, int min, int max) |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1793 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1794 char *curstr = tern_find_path(config, path, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1795 int curval = curstr ? atoi(curstr) : def; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1796 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1797 int val = curval; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1798 nk_property_int(context, name, min, &val, max, 1, 1.0f); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1799 if (val != curval) { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1800 char buffer[12]; |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1801 sprintf(buffer, "%d", val); |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
1802 config_dirty = 1; |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1803 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(buffer)}, TVAL_PTR); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1804 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1805 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
1806 |
1796
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1807 void settings_float_property(struct nk_context *context, char *label, char *name, char *path, float def, float min, float max, float step) |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1808 { |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1809 char *curstr = tern_find_path(config, path, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1810 float curval = curstr ? atof(curstr) : def; |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1811 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1812 float val = curval; |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1813 nk_property_float(context, name, min, &val, max, step, step); |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1814 if (val != curval) { |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1815 char buffer[64]; |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1816 sprintf(buffer, "%f", val); |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1817 config_dirty = 1; |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1818 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(buffer)}, TVAL_PTR); |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1819 } |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1820 } |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
1821 |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1822 typedef struct { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1823 char *fragment; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1824 char *vertex; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1825 } shader_prog; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1826 |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1827 shader_prog *get_shader_progs(dir_entry *entries, size_t num_entries, shader_prog *progs, uint32_t *num_existing, uint32_t *storage) |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1828 { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1829 uint32_t num_progs = *num_existing; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1830 uint32_t prog_storage = *storage; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1831 uint32_t starting = num_progs; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1832 |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1833 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_entries; i++) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1834 if (entries[i].is_dir) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1835 continue; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1836 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1837 char *no_ext = basename_no_extension(entries[i].name); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1838 uint32_t len = strlen(no_ext); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1839 if (no_ext[len-1] == 'f' && no_ext[len-2] == '.') { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1840 uint8_t dupe = 0;; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1841 for (uint32_t j = 0; j < starting; j++) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1842 if (!strcmp(entries[i].name, progs[j].fragment)) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1843 dupe = 1; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1844 break; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1845 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1846 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1847 if (!dupe) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1848 if (num_progs == prog_storage) { |
1493
24f44f26b74d
Fix buffer overrun in video settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1492
diff
changeset
|
1849 prog_storage = prog_storage ? prog_storage*2 : 4; |
1857
1844cf5a4045
Fix buffer overrun in shader list UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1855
diff
changeset
|
1850 progs = realloc(progs, sizeof(*progs) * prog_storage); |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1851 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1852 progs[num_progs].vertex = NULL; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1853 progs[num_progs++].fragment = strdup(entries[i].name); |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1854 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1855 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1856 free(no_ext); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1857 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
1858 |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1859 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_entries; i++) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1860 if (entries[i].is_dir) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1861 continue; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1862 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1863 char *no_ext = basename_no_extension(entries[i].name); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1864 uint32_t len = strlen(no_ext); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1865 if (no_ext[len-1] == 'v' && no_ext[len-2] == '.') { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1866 for (uint32_t j = 0; j < num_progs; j++) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1867 if (!strncmp(no_ext, progs[j].fragment, len-1) && progs[j].fragment[len-1] == 'f' && progs[j].fragment[len] == '.') { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1868 progs[j].vertex = strdup(entries[i].name); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1869 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1870 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1871 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1872 free(no_ext); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1873 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1874 free_dir_list(entries, num_entries); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1875 *num_existing = num_progs; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1876 *storage = prog_storage; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1877 return progs; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1878 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1879 |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1880 shader_prog *get_shader_list(uint32_t *num_out) |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1881 { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1882 char *shader_dir = path_append(get_config_dir(), "shaders"); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1883 size_t num_entries; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1884 dir_entry *entries = get_dir_list(shader_dir, &num_entries); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1885 free(shader_dir); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1886 shader_prog *progs; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1887 uint32_t num_progs = 0, prog_storage; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1888 if (num_entries) { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1889 progs = calloc(num_entries, sizeof(shader_prog)); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1890 prog_storage = num_entries; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1891 progs = get_shader_progs(entries, num_entries, progs, &num_progs, &prog_storage); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1892 } else { |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1893 progs = NULL; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1894 prog_storage = 0; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1895 } |
1693
ba3fb7a3be6b
Added some Makefile options to build a packaging friendly executable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1681
diff
changeset
|
1896 #ifdef DATA_PATH |
ba3fb7a3be6b
Added some Makefile options to build a packaging friendly executable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1681
diff
changeset
|
1897 shader_dir = path_append(DATA_PATH, "shaders"); |
ba3fb7a3be6b
Added some Makefile options to build a packaging friendly executable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1681
diff
changeset
|
1898 #else |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1899 shader_dir = path_append(get_exe_dir(), "shaders"); |
1693
ba3fb7a3be6b
Added some Makefile options to build a packaging friendly executable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1681
diff
changeset
|
1900 #endif |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1901 entries = get_dir_list(shader_dir, &num_entries); |
1858
dda7479f3bbb
Fix a couple of small memory leaks
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1857
diff
changeset
|
1902 free(shader_dir); |
1492
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1903 progs = get_shader_progs(entries, num_entries, progs, &num_progs, &prog_storage); |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1904 *num_out = num_progs; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1905 return progs; |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1906 } |
bdeb2a1d0385
Add shader selector to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1491
diff
changeset
|
1907 |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1908 int32_t find_match(const char **options, uint32_t num_options, char *path, char *def) |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1909 { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1910 char *setting = tern_find_path_default(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = def}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1911 int32_t selected = -1; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1912 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_options; i++) |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1913 { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1914 if (!strcmp(setting, options[i])) { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1915 selected = i; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1916 break; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1917 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1918 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1919 if (selected == -1) { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1920 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_options; i++) |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1921 { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1922 if (!strcmp(def, options[i])) { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1923 selected = i; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1924 break; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1925 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1926 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1927 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1928 return selected; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1929 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1930 |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1931 int32_t settings_dropdown_ex(struct nk_context *context, char *label, const char **options, const char **opt_display, uint32_t num_options, int32_t current, char *path) |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1932 { |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1933 nk_label(context, label, NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1934 int32_t next = nk_combo(context, opt_display, num_options, current, 30, nk_vec2(300, 300)); |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1935 if (next != current) { |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
1936 config_dirty = 1; |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1937 config = tern_insert_path(config, path, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(options[next])}, TVAL_PTR); |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1938 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1939 return next; |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1940 } |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
1941 |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1942 int32_t settings_dropdown(struct nk_context *context, char *label, const char **options, uint32_t num_options, int32_t current, char *path) |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1943 { |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1944 return settings_dropdown_ex(context, label, options, options, num_options, current, path); |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1945 } |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
1946 |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1947 void view_video_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1948 { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1949 const char *vsync_opts[] = {"on", "off", "tear"}; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1950 const char *vsync_opt_names[] = { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1951 "On", |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1952 "Off", |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1953 "On, tear if late" |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1954 }; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1955 const uint32_t num_vsync_opts = sizeof(vsync_opts)/sizeof(*vsync_opts); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1956 static shader_prog *progs; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1957 static char **prog_names; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1958 static uint32_t num_progs; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1959 static uint32_t selected_prog; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1960 static int32_t selected_vsync = -1; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1961 if (selected_vsync < 0) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1962 selected_vsync = find_match(vsync_opts, num_vsync_opts, "video\0vsync\0", "off"); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1963 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1964 if(!progs) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1965 progs = get_shader_list(&num_progs); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1966 prog_names = calloc(num_progs, sizeof(char*)); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1967 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_progs; i++) |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1968 { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1969 prog_names[i] = basename_no_extension(progs[i].fragment);; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1970 uint32_t len = strlen(prog_names[i]); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1971 if (len > 2) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1972 prog_names[i][len-2] = 0; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1973 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1974 if (!progs[i].vertex) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1975 progs[i].vertex = strdup("default.v.glsl"); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1976 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1977 if (!strcmp( |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1978 progs[i].fragment, |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1979 tern_find_path_default(config, "video\0fragment_shader\0", (tern_val){.ptrval = "default.f.glsl"}, TVAL_PTR).ptrval |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1980 )) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1981 selected_prog = i; |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1982 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1983 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1984 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1985 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1986 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
1577
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
1987 uint32_t desired_width = context->style.font->height * 10; |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
1988 if (desired_width > width) { |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
1989 desired_width = width; |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
1990 } |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1991 if (nk_begin(context, "Video Settings", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1577
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
1992 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, desired_width, 2); |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1993 settings_toggle(context, "Fullscreen", "video\0fullscreen\0", 0); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1994 settings_toggle(context, "Open GL", "video\0gl\0", 1); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1995 settings_toggle(context, "Scanlines", "video\0scanlines\0", 0); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1996 selected_vsync = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "VSync", vsync_opts, vsync_opt_names, num_vsync_opts, selected_vsync, "video\0vsync\0"); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1997 settings_int_input(context, "Windowed Width", "video\0width\0", "640"); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
1998 nk_label(context, "Shader", NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
1577
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
1999 uint32_t next_selected = nk_combo(context, (const char **)prog_names, num_progs, selected_prog, context->style.font->height, nk_vec2(desired_width, desired_width)); |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2000 if (next_selected != selected_prog) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2001 selected_prog = next_selected; |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2002 config_dirty = 1; |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2003 config = tern_insert_path(config, "video\0fragment_shader\0", (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(progs[next_selected].fragment)}, TVAL_PTR); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2004 config = tern_insert_path(config, "video\0vertex_shader\0", (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(progs[next_selected].vertex)}, TVAL_PTR); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2005 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2006 settings_int_property(context, "NTSC Overscan", "Top", "video\0ntsc\0overscan\0top\0", 2, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2007 settings_int_property(context, "", "Bottom", "video\0ntsc\0overscan\0bottom\0", 17, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2008 settings_int_property(context, "", "Left", "video\0ntsc\0overscan\0left\0", 13, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2009 settings_int_property(context, "", "Right", "video\0ntsc\0overscan\0right\0", 14, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2010 settings_int_property(context, "PAL Overscan", "Top", "video\0pal\0overscan\0top\0", 2, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2011 settings_int_property(context, "", "Bottom", "video\0pal\0overscan\0bottom\0", 17, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2012 settings_int_property(context, "", "Left", "video\0pal\0overscan\0left\0", 13, 0, 32); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2013 settings_int_property(context, "", "Right", "video\0pal\0overscan\0right\0", 14, 0, 32); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2014 |
1553
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2015 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2016 pop_view(); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2017 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2018 nk_end(context); |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2019 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2020 } |
723c00950f41
Added vsync to video settings
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1549
diff
changeset
|
2021 |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2022 void view_audio_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2023 { |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2024 const char *rates[] = { |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2025 "192000", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2026 "96000", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2027 "48000", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2028 "44100", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2029 "22050" |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2030 }; |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2031 const char *sizes[] = { |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2032 "1024", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2033 "512", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2034 "256", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2035 "128", |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2036 "64" |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2037 }; |
1798
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2038 const char *dac[] = { |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2039 "zero_offset", |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2040 "linear" |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2041 }; |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2042 const char *dac_desc[] = { |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2043 "Zero Offset", |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2044 "Linear" |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2045 }; |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2046 const uint32_t num_rates = sizeof(rates)/sizeof(*rates); |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2047 const uint32_t num_sizes = sizeof(sizes)/sizeof(*sizes); |
1798
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2048 const uint32_t num_dacs = sizeof(dac)/sizeof(*dac); |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2049 static int32_t selected_rate = -1; |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2050 static int32_t selected_size = -1; |
1798
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2051 static int32_t selected_dac = -1; |
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2052 if (selected_rate < 0 || selected_size < 0 || selected_dac < 0) { |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
2053 selected_rate = find_match(rates, num_rates, "autio\0rate\0", "48000"); |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
2054 selected_size = find_match(sizes, num_sizes, "audio\0buffer\0", "512"); |
1798
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2055 selected_dac = find_match(dac, num_dacs, "audio\0fm_dac\0", "zero_offset"); |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2056 } |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2057 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2058 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2059 uint32_t desired_width = context->style.font->height * 10; |
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2060 if (desired_width > width) { |
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2061 desired_width = width; |
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2062 } |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2063 if (nk_begin(context, "Audio Settings", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2064 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height , desired_width, 2); |
1499
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
2065 selected_rate = settings_dropdown(context, "Rate in Hz", rates, num_rates, selected_rate, "audio\0rate\0"); |
756f8616d1bf
Refactor basic settings dropdowns
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1498
diff
changeset
|
2066 selected_size = settings_dropdown(context, "Buffer Samples", sizes, num_sizes, selected_size, "audio\0buffer\0"); |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2067 settings_int_input(context, "Lowpass Cutoff Hz", "audio\0lowpass_cutoff\0", "3390"); |
1811
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2068 settings_float_property(context, "Gain (dB)", "Overall", "audio\0gain\0", 0, -30.0f, 30.0f, 0.5f); |
1796
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
2069 settings_float_property(context, "", "FM", "audio\0fm_gain\0", 0, -30.0f, 30.0f, 0.5f); |
51417bb557b6
Configurable gain for overall output and individual components
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1790
diff
changeset
|
2070 settings_float_property(context, "", "PSG", "audio\0psg_gain\0", 0, -30.0f, 30.0f, 0.5f); |
2277
9e578fd493e1
Implement gain control for Ricoh PCM and CDDA with defaults based on Model 2 Sega CD
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2247
diff
changeset
|
2071 settings_float_property(context, "", "RF5C164", "audio\0rf5c164_gain\0", -6.0f, -30.0f, 30.0f, 0.5f); |
9e578fd493e1
Implement gain control for Ricoh PCM and CDDA with defaults based on Model 2 Sega CD
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2247
diff
changeset
|
2072 settings_float_property(context, "", "CDDA", "audio\0cdd_gain\0", -9.5f, -30.0f, 30.0f, 0.5f); |
1798
5278b6e44fc1
Optionally emulate the offset around zero in the imperfect DAC of a discrete YM2612
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1796
diff
changeset
|
2073 selected_dac = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "FM DAC", dac, dac_desc, num_dacs, selected_dac, "audio\0fm_dac\0"); |
1494
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2074 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2075 pop_view(); |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2076 } |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2077 nk_end(context); |
8be6ea919300
Fleshed out audio settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1493
diff
changeset
|
2078 } |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2079 } |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2080 typedef struct { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2081 const char **models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2082 const char **names; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2083 uint32_t num_models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2084 uint32_t storage; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2085 uint8_t genesis_only; |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2086 } model_foreach_state; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2087 void model_iter(char *key, tern_val val, uint8_t valtype, void *data) |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2088 { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2089 if (valtype != TVAL_NODE) { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2090 return; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2091 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2092 if (!strcmp(tern_find_ptr_default(val.ptrval, "show", "yes"), "no")) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2093 return; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2094 } |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2095 model_foreach_state *state = data; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2096 if (state->genesis_only && strcmp(tern_find_ptr_default(val.ptrval, "vdp", "genesis"), "genesis")) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2097 return; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2098 } |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2099 if (state->num_models == state->storage) { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2100 state->storage *= 2; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2101 state->models = realloc(state->models, state->storage * sizeof(char *)); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2102 state->names = realloc(state->names, state->storage * sizeof(char *)); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2103 } |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2104 char *def = strdup(key); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2105 state->models[state->num_models] = def; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2106 state->names[state->num_models++] = tern_find_ptr_default(val.ptrval, "name", def); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2107 } |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2108 |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2109 typedef struct { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2110 const char **models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2111 const char **names; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2112 } models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2113 |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2114 models get_models(uint32_t *num_out, uint8_t genesis_only) |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2115 { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2116 tern_node *systems = get_systems_config(); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2117 model_foreach_state state = { |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2118 .models = calloc(4, sizeof(char *)), |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2119 .names = calloc(4, sizeof(char *)), |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2120 .num_models = 0, |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2121 .storage = 4, |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2122 .genesis_only = genesis_only |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2123 }; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2124 tern_foreach(systems, model_iter, &state); |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2125 *num_out = state.num_models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2126 return (models){ |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2127 .models = state.models, |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2128 .names = state.names |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2129 }; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2130 } |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2131 |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2132 void view_system_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2133 { |
1568
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2134 const char *sync_opts[] = { |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2135 "video", |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2136 "audio" |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2137 }; |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2138 const uint32_t num_sync_opts = sizeof(sync_opts)/sizeof(*sync_opts); |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2139 static int32_t selected_sync = -1; |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2140 if (selected_sync < 0) { |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2141 selected_sync = find_match(sync_opts, num_sync_opts, "system\0sync_source\0", "video"); |
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2142 } |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2143 const char *regions[] = { |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2144 "J - Japan", |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2145 "U - Americas", |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2146 "E - Europe" |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2147 }; |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2148 const char *region_codes[] = {"J", "U", "E"}; |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2149 const uint32_t num_regions = sizeof(regions)/sizeof(*regions); |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2150 static int32_t selected_region = -1; |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2151 if (selected_region < 0) { |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2152 selected_region = find_match(region_codes, num_regions, "system\0default_region\0", "U"); |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2153 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2154 static const char **model_opts, **sms_model_opts; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2155 static const char **model_names, **sms_model_names; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2156 static uint32_t num_models, num_sms_models; |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2157 if (!model_opts) { |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2158 models m = get_models(&num_models, 1); |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2159 model_opts = m.models; |
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2160 model_names = m.names; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2161 m = get_models(&num_sms_models, 0); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2162 sms_model_opts = m.models; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2163 sms_model_names = m.names; |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2164 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2165 static uint8_t old_show_sms; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2166 uint8_t show_sms = current_system && current_system->type == SYSTEM_SMS; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2167 |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2168 static int32_t selected_model = -1; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2169 if (selected_model < 0 || show_sms != old_show_sms) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2170 if (show_sms) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2171 selected_model = find_match(sms_model_opts, num_sms_models, "sms\0system\0model\0", "md1va3"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2172 } else { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2173 selected_model = find_match(model_opts, num_models, "system\0model\0", "md1va3"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2174 } |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2175 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2176 |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2177 static const char *formats[] = { |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2178 "native", |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2179 "gst" |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2180 }; |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2181 const uint32_t num_formats = sizeof(formats)/sizeof(*formats); |
1900
93960907807a
Added UI for selecting configured model
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1862
diff
changeset
|
2182 static int32_t selected_format = -1; |
1500
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2183 if (selected_format < 0) { |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2184 selected_format = find_match(formats, num_formats, "ui\0state_format\0", "native"); |
39a199dca772
Added dropdowns for default region and savestate format
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1499
diff
changeset
|
2185 } |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2186 static const char *ram_inits[] = { |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2187 "zero", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2188 "random" |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2189 }; |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2190 const uint32_t num_inits = sizeof(ram_inits)/sizeof(*ram_inits); |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2191 static int32_t selected_init = -1; |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2192 if (selected_init < 0) { |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2193 selected_init = find_match(ram_inits, num_inits, "system\0ram_init\0", "zero"); |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2194 } |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2195 static const char *io_opts_1[] = { |
1789
b3eb74936f18
Fix off by one in IO device UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1693
diff
changeset
|
2196 "none", |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2197 "gamepad2.1", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2198 "gamepad3.1", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2199 "gamepad6.1", |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2200 "sega_multitap.1", |
2238
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2201 "ea_multitap_port_a", |
1575
ccb3a8ae7ad0
Fix config value set when "Mega Mouse" is selected in settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1573
diff
changeset
|
2202 "mouse.1", |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2203 "saturn keyboard", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2204 "xband keyboard" |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2205 }; |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2206 static const char *io_opts_2[] = { |
1789
b3eb74936f18
Fix off by one in IO device UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1693
diff
changeset
|
2207 "none", |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2208 "gamepad2.2", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2209 "gamepad3.2", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2210 "gamepad6.2", |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2211 "sega_multitap.1", |
2238
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2212 "ea_multitap_port_b", |
1575
ccb3a8ae7ad0
Fix config value set when "Mega Mouse" is selected in settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1573
diff
changeset
|
2213 "mouse.1", |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2214 "saturn keyboard", |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2215 "xband keyboard" |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2216 }; |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2217 static const char *type_names[sizeof(io_opts_1)/sizeof(*io_opts_1)]; |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2218 static int32_t selected_io_1 = -1; |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2219 static int32_t selected_io_2 = -1; |
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2220 const uint32_t num_io = sizeof(io_opts_1)/sizeof(*io_opts_1); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2221 if (selected_io_1 < 0 || selected_io_2 < 0 || show_sms != old_show_sms) { |
2235
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2222 type_names[0] = device_type_names[IO_NONE]; |
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2223 type_names[1] = device_type_names[IO_GAMEPAD2]; |
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2224 type_names[2] = device_type_names[IO_GAMEPAD3]; |
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2225 type_names[3] = device_type_names[IO_GAMEPAD6]; |
93918a6a8ab7
Initial support for Sega multi-tap
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2220
diff
changeset
|
2226 type_names[4] = device_type_names[IO_SEGA_MULTI]; |
2238
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2227 type_names[5] = device_type_names[IO_EA_MULTI_A]; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2228 type_names[6] = device_type_names[IO_MOUSE]; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2229 type_names[7] = device_type_names[IO_SATURN_KEYBOARD]; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2230 type_names[8] = device_type_names[IO_XBAND_KEYBOARD]; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2231 if (show_sms) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2232 selected_io_1 = find_match(io_opts_1, num_io, "sms\0io\0devices\0""1\0", "gamepad2.1"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2233 selected_io_2 = find_match(io_opts_2, num_io, "sms\0io\0devices\0""2\0", "gamepad2.2"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2234 } else { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2235 selected_io_1 = find_match(io_opts_1, num_io, "io\0devices\0""1\0", "gamepad6.1"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2236 selected_io_2 = find_match(io_opts_2, num_io, "io\0devices\0""2\0", "gamepad6.2"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2237 } |
1501
31a2997b745e
Added RAM init and IO port config to system settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1500
diff
changeset
|
2238 } |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2239 old_show_sms = show_sms; |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2240 |
1498
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2241 uint32_t width = render_width(); |
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2242 uint32_t height = render_height(); |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2243 uint32_t desired_width = context->style.font->height * 10; |
1498
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2244 if (nk_begin(context, "System Settings", nk_rect(0, 0, width, height), 0)) { |
1578
aaa28c9bf67d
Basic interface scaling for rest of settings UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1577
diff
changeset
|
2245 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, desired_width, 2); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2246 |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2247 if (show_sms) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2248 selected_model = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "Model", sms_model_opts, sms_model_names, num_sms_models, selected_model, "sms\0system\0model\0"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2249 } else { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2250 selected_model = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "Model", model_opts, model_names, num_models, selected_model, "system\0model\0"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2251 } |
2238
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2252 int32_t old_selected = selected_io_1; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2253 char *config_path1, *config_path2; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2254 if (show_sms) { |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2255 config_path1 = "sms\0io\0devices\0""1\0"; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2256 config_path2 = "sms\0io\0devices\0""2\0"; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2257 } else { |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2258 config_path1 = "io\0devices\0""1\0"; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2259 config_path2 = "io\0devices\0""2\0"; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2260 } |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2261 selected_io_1 = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "IO Port 1 Device", io_opts_1, type_names, num_io, selected_io_1, config_path1); |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2262 if (old_selected != selected_io_1 && selected_io_1 != selected_io_2 && !strcmp(io_opts_1[selected_io_1], "ea_multitap_port_a")) { |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2263 selected_io_2 = selected_io_1; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2264 config = tern_insert_path(config, config_path2, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(io_opts_2[selected_io_2])}, TVAL_PTR); |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2265 } |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2266 old_selected = selected_io_2; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2267 selected_io_2 = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "IO Port 2 Device", io_opts_2, type_names, num_io, selected_io_2, config_path2); |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2268 if (old_selected != selected_io_2 && selected_io_1 != selected_io_2 && !strcmp(io_opts_2[selected_io_2], "ea_multitap_port_b")) { |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2269 selected_io_1 = selected_io_2; |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2270 config = tern_insert_path(config, config_path1, (tern_val){.ptrval = strdup(io_opts_1[selected_io_1])}, TVAL_PTR); |
0a107b2d5837
Add support for EA 4-way Play
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2235
diff
changeset
|
2271 } |
2014
9ca255be938d
Reorder system settings so that more common options are near the top and none of the dropdowns get cut off
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2003
diff
changeset
|
2272 selected_region = settings_dropdown_ex(context, "Default Region", region_codes, regions, num_regions, selected_region, "system\0default_region\0"); |
1568
d14490dee01f
Add sync_source to default.cfg and the Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1554
diff
changeset
|
2273 selected_sync = settings_dropdown(context, "Sync Source", sync_opts, num_sync_opts, selected_sync, "system\0sync_source\0"); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2274 if (!show_sms) { |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2275 settings_int_property(context, "68000 Clock Divider", "", "clocks\0m68k_divider\0", 7, 1, 53); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2276 selected_format = settings_dropdown(context, "Save State Format", formats, num_formats, selected_format, "ui\0state_format\0"); |
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2277 } |
2014
9ca255be938d
Reorder system settings so that more common options are near the top and none of the dropdowns get cut off
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2003
diff
changeset
|
2278 selected_init = settings_dropdown(context, "Initial RAM Value", ram_inits, num_inits, selected_init, "system\0ram_init\0"); |
1498
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2279 settings_toggle(context, "Remember ROM Path", "ui\0remember_path\0", 1); |
1852
a4cae960fd08
Allow config file to be saved with executable for "portable" setups
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1841
diff
changeset
|
2280 settings_toggle(context, "Save config with EXE", "ui\0config_in_exe_dir\0", 0); |
1853
9b2acecf8124
Allow game save path to be edited from UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1852
diff
changeset
|
2281 settings_string(context, "Game Save Path", "ui\0save_path\0", "$USERDATA/blastem/$ROMNAME"); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2282 |
1498
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2283 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2284 pop_view(); |
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2285 } |
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2286 nk_end(context); |
050a5b032bc5
Initial work on system menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1494
diff
changeset
|
2287 } |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2288 } |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2289 |
2018
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2290 void view_confirm_reset(struct nk_context *context) |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2291 { |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2292 if (nk_begin(context, "Reset Confirm", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2293 uint32_t desired_width = context->style.font->height * 20; |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2294 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, desired_width, 1); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2295 nk_label(context, "This will reset all settings and controller", NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2296 nk_label(context, "mappings back to the defaults.", NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2297 nk_label(context, "Are you sure you want to proceed?", NK_TEXT_LEFT); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2298 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height * 1.5, desired_width / 2, 2); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2299 if (nk_button_label(context, "Maybe not")) { |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2300 pop_view(); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2301 } |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2302 if (nk_button_label(context, "Yep, delete it all")) { |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2303 delete_custom_config(); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2304 config = load_config(); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2305 delete_controller_info(); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2306 config_dirty = 1; |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2307 pop_view(); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2308 } |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2309 nk_end(context); |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2310 } |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2311 } |
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2312 |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2313 void view_bios_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2314 { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2315 if (nk_begin(context, "Firmware", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2316 uint32_t desired_width = context->style.font->height * 10; |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2317 nk_layout_row_static(context, context->style.font->height, desired_width, 2); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2318 static const char* exts[] = {"md", "bin", "smd"}; |
2247
08a16de0e4cb
Fix settings save path of TMSS ROM setting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2238
diff
changeset
|
2319 settings_path(context, "TMSS ROM", "system\0tmss_path\0", "tmss.md", exts, 3); |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2320 settings_path(context, "US CD BIOS", "system\0scd_bios_us\0", "cdbios.md", exts, 3); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2321 settings_path(context, "JP CD BIOS", "system\0scd_bios_jp\0", "cdbios.md", exts, 3); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2322 settings_path(context, "EU CD BIOS", "system\0scd_bios_eu\0", "cdbios.md", exts, 3); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2323 if (nk_button_label(context, "Back")) { |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2324 pop_view(); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2325 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2326 nk_end(context); |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2327 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2328 } |
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2329 |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2330 void view_back(struct nk_context *context) |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2331 { |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2332 pop_view(); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2333 pop_view(); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2334 current_view(context); |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2335 } |
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2336 |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2337 void view_settings(struct nk_context *context) |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2338 { |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2339 static menu_item items[] = { |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2340 {"Key Bindings", view_key_bindings}, |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2341 {"Controllers", view_controllers}, |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2342 {"Video", view_video_settings}, |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2343 {"Audio", view_audio_settings}, |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2344 {"System", view_system_settings}, |
2156
237068a25523
Added UI for setting firmware paths
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2022
diff
changeset
|
2345 {"Firmware", view_bios_settings}, |
2018
193b804c9845
Add a UI button to reset config to defaults
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2017
diff
changeset
|
2346 {"Reset to Defaults", view_confirm_reset}, |
1491
e890971f3757
Somewhat fleshed out video settings view
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1490
diff
changeset
|
2347 {"Back", view_back} |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2348 }; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2349 |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2350 if (nk_begin(context, "Settings Menu", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2351 menu(context, sizeof(items)/sizeof(*items), items, NULL); |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2352 nk_end(context); |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2353 } |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2354 } |
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2355 |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2356 void exit_handler(uint32_t index) |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2357 { |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2358 exit(0); |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2359 } |
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2360 |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2361 void view_pause(struct nk_context *context) |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2362 { |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2363 static menu_item items[] = { |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2364 {"Resume", view_play}, |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2365 {"Load ROM", view_load}, |
1487
6a35815cc409
Enable lock-on in Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1486
diff
changeset
|
2366 {"Lock On", view_lock_on}, |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2367 {"Save State", view_save_state}, |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2368 {"Load State", view_load_state}, |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2369 {"Settings", view_settings}, |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2370 {"Exit", NULL} |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2371 }; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2372 |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2373 if (nk_begin(context, "Main Menu", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2374 menu(context, sizeof(items)/sizeof(*items), items, exit_handler); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2375 nk_end(context); |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2376 } |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2377 } |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2378 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2379 void view_menu(struct nk_context *context) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2380 { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2381 static menu_item items[] = { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2382 {"Load ROM", view_load}, |
1490
919c0c33885e
Initial work on settings menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1487
diff
changeset
|
2383 {"Settings", view_settings}, |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2384 {"About", view_about}, |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2385 {"Exit", NULL} |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2386 }; |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2387 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2388 if (nk_begin(context, "Main Menu", nk_rect(0, 0, render_width(), render_height()), 0)) { |
1645
84ef1eb2c96a
Added code for actually saving new controller bindings to an appropriate key in the config file
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1626
diff
changeset
|
2389 menu(context, sizeof(items)/sizeof(*items), items, exit_handler); |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2390 nk_end(context); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2391 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2392 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2393 |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2394 void blastem_nuklear_render(void) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2395 { |
1658
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2396 if (current_view != view_play) { |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2397 nk_input_end(context); |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2398 current_view(context); |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2399 if (fb_context) { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2400 fb_context->fb.pixels = render_get_framebuffer(FRAMEBUFFER_UI, &fb_context->fb.pitch); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2401 nk_rawfb_render(fb_context, nk_rgb(0,0,0), 0); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2402 render_framebuffer_updated(FRAMEBUFFER_UI, render_width()); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2403 } else { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2404 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2405 nk_sdl_render(NK_ANTI_ALIASING_ON, 512 * 1024, 128 * 1024); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2406 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2407 } |
1658
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2408 nk_input_begin(context); |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2409 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2410 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2411 |
1486
a6881d0d76d0
Pause game execution when in the new UI pause menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1485
diff
changeset
|
2412 void ui_idle_loop(void) |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2413 { |
1862
e07fc3d473b2
Basic UI navigation with controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1859
diff
changeset
|
2414 render_enable_gamepad_events(1); |
1482
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2415 const uint32_t MIN_UI_DELAY = 15; |
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2416 static uint32_t last; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2417 while (current_view != view_play) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2418 { |
1482
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2419 uint32_t current = render_elapsed_ms(); |
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2420 if ((current - last) < MIN_UI_DELAY) { |
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2421 render_sleep_ms(MIN_UI_DELAY - (current - last) - 1); |
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2422 } |
2d203bf73dbd
Avoid burning a huge amount of CPU in the menu when emulation is not running and vsync is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1481
diff
changeset
|
2423 last = current; |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2424 render_update_display(); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2425 } |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2426 if (config_dirty) { |
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2427 apply_updated_config(); |
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2428 persist_config(config); |
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2429 config_dirty = 0; |
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2430 } |
1862
e07fc3d473b2
Basic UI navigation with controller
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1859
diff
changeset
|
2431 render_enable_gamepad_events(0); |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2432 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2433 static void handle_event(SDL_Event *event) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2434 { |
1522
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
2435 if (event->type == SDL_KEYDOWN) { |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
2436 keycode = event->key.keysym.sym; |
63659fb92db4
Key binding menu is now functional
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1521
diff
changeset
|
2437 } |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2438 else if (event->type == SDL_JOYBUTTONDOWN) { |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2439 button_pressed = event->jbutton.button; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2440 } |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2441 else if (event->type == SDL_JOYHATMOTION) { |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2442 hat_moved = event->jhat.hat; |
1600
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2443 hat_value = event->jhat.value; |
7f39c40b4b25
WIP UI for creating an SDL2 mapping for controllers that don't have one
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1599
diff
changeset
|
2444 } |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2445 else if (event->type == SDL_JOYAXISMOTION) { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2446 if (event->jaxis.axis == axis_moved || abs(event->jaxis.value) > abs(axis_value) || abs(event->jaxis.value) > 1000) { |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2447 axis_moved = event->jaxis.axis; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2448 axis_value = event->jaxis.value; |
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2449 } |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2450 } else if (event->type == SDL_MOUSEBUTTONDOWN && event->button.button == 0) { |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2451 click = 1; |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2452 } else if (event->type == SDL_MOUSEBUTTONUP && event->button.button == 0) { |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2453 click = 0; |
1601
da04dd9c89ad
SDL2 mapping UI now handles axes
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1600
diff
changeset
|
2454 } |
2317
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
2455 if (stick_nav_disabled && event->type == SDL_CONTROLLERAXISMOTION) { |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
2456 return; |
e836cf11783b
Make deadzones configurable and bump up the default value
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2313
diff
changeset
|
2457 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2458 nk_sdl_handle_event(event); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2459 } |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2460 |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2461 static void context_destroyed(void) |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2462 { |
1681
3f1c8258e20f
Hopefully fix Nuklear assert when loading ROM after changing video settings that some users are reporting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1675
diff
changeset
|
2463 if (context) |
3f1c8258e20f
Hopefully fix Nuklear assert when loading ROM after changing video settings that some users are reporting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1675
diff
changeset
|
2464 { |
3f1c8258e20f
Hopefully fix Nuklear assert when loading ROM after changing video settings that some users are reporting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1675
diff
changeset
|
2465 nk_sdl_shutdown(); |
3f1c8258e20f
Hopefully fix Nuklear assert when loading ROM after changing video settings that some users are reporting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1675
diff
changeset
|
2466 context = NULL; |
3f1c8258e20f
Hopefully fix Nuklear assert when loading ROM after changing video settings that some users are reporting
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1675
diff
changeset
|
2467 } |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2468 } |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2469 |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2470 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
1609
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2471 static struct nk_image load_image_texture(uint32_t *buf, uint32_t width, uint32_t height) |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2472 { |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2473 GLuint tex; |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2474 glGenTextures(1, &tex); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2475 glBindTexture(GL_TEXTURE_2D, tex); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2476 glTexParameterf(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_MIN_FILTER, GL_LINEAR); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2477 glTexParameterf(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_MAG_FILTER, GL_LINEAR); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2478 glTexParameterf(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_WRAP_S, GL_CLAMP_TO_EDGE); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2479 glTexParameterf(GL_TEXTURE_2D, GL_TEXTURE_WRAP_T, GL_CLAMP_TO_EDGE); |
1658
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2480 #ifdef USE_GLES |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2481 glTexImage2D(GL_TEXTURE_2D, 0, GL_RGBA, width, height, 0, GL_RGBA, GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE, buf); |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2482 #else |
1609
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2483 glTexImage2D(GL_TEXTURE_2D, 0, GL_RGBA8, width, height, 0, GL_BGRA, GL_UNSIGNED_BYTE, buf); |
1658
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2484 #endif |
1609
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2485 return nk_image_id((int)tex); |
9c8f58740450
Added PS4 controller image. Added code to use PS4 image for Playstation controllers
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1606
diff
changeset
|
2486 } |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2487 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2488 |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2489 static struct nk_image load_image_rawfb(uint32_t *buf, uint32_t width, uint32_t height) |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2490 { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2491 struct rawfb_image *fbimg = calloc(1, sizeof(struct rawfb_image)); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2492 fbimg->pixels = buf; |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2493 fbimg->pitch = width * sizeof(uint32_t); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2494 fbimg->w = width; |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2495 fbimg->h = height; |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2496 fbimg->format = NK_FONT_ATLAS_RGBA32; |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2497 return nk_image_ptr(fbimg); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2498 } |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2499 |
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2500 static void texture_init(void) |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2501 { |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2502 struct nk_font_atlas *atlas; |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2503 if (fb_context) { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2504 nk_rawfb_font_stash_begin(fb_context, &atlas); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2505 } else { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2506 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2507 nk_sdl_font_stash_begin(&atlas); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2508 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2509 } |
1527
4f6e8acd7b6a
Added support for TTC and dfont format true type fonts. More robust font selection on Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1526
diff
changeset
|
2510 uint32_t font_size; |
4f6e8acd7b6a
Added support for TTC and dfont format true type fonts. More robust font selection on Windows
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1526
diff
changeset
|
2511 uint8_t *font = default_font(&font_size); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2512 if (!font) { |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2513 fatal_error("Failed to find default font path\n"); |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2514 } |
2294
7e995fb948c3
Make UI font less comically large
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2277
diff
changeset
|
2515 def_font = nk_font_atlas_add_from_memory(atlas, font, font_size, render_height() / 24, NULL); |
1593
24508cb54f87
Fix a number of other memory errors (mostly leaks again) identified by valgrind
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1581
diff
changeset
|
2516 free(font); |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2517 if (fb_context) { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2518 nk_rawfb_font_stash_end(fb_context); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2519 } else { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2520 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2521 nk_sdl_font_stash_end(); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2522 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2523 } |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2524 nk_style_set_font(context, &def_font->handle); |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2525 for (uint32_t i = 0; i < num_ui_images; i++) |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2526 { |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2527 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2528 if (fb_context) { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2529 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2530 ui_images[i]->ui = load_image_rawfb(ui_images[i]->image_data, ui_images[i]->width, ui_images[i]->height); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2531 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2532 } else { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2533 ui_images[i]->ui = load_image_texture(ui_images[i]->image_data, ui_images[i]->width, ui_images[i]->height); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2534 } |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2535 #endif |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2536 } |
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2537 } |
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2538 |
1811
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2539 static void style_init(void) |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2540 { |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2541 context->style.checkbox.padding.x = render_height() / 120; |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2542 context->style.checkbox.padding.y = render_height() / 120; |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2543 context->style.checkbox.border = render_height() / 240; |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2544 context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.type = NK_STYLE_ITEM_COLOR; |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2545 context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal.data.color = (struct nk_color){ |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2546 .r = 255, .g = 128, .b = 0, .a = 255 |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2547 }; |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2548 context->style.checkbox.cursor_hover = context->style.checkbox.cursor_normal; |
1854
58b6f5d918f4
Minor improvements to keyboard navigation
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1853
diff
changeset
|
2549 context->style.property.inc_button.text_hover = (struct nk_color){ |
58b6f5d918f4
Minor improvements to keyboard navigation
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1853
diff
changeset
|
2550 .r = 255, .g = 128, .b = 0, .a = 255 |
58b6f5d918f4
Minor improvements to keyboard navigation
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1853
diff
changeset
|
2551 }; |
58b6f5d918f4
Minor improvements to keyboard navigation
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1853
diff
changeset
|
2552 context->style.property.dec_button.text_hover = context->style.property.inc_button.text_hover; |
1855
92532eb6986d
Make combo boxes keyboard navigable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1854
diff
changeset
|
2553 context->style.combo.button.text_hover = context->style.property.inc_button.text_hover; |
1811
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2554 } |
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2555 |
2308
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2556 static void fb_resize(void) |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2557 { |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2558 nk_rawfb_resize_fb(fb_context, NULL, render_width(), render_height(), 0); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2559 style_init(); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2560 texture_init(); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2561 } |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2562 |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2563 static void context_created(void) |
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2564 { |
1573
a051d8ee4528
Only save config file if something has changed. Re-initialize audio and video with new settings if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1572
diff
changeset
|
2565 context = nk_sdl_init(render_get_window()); |
2308
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2566 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2567 if (render_has_gl()) { |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2568 nk_sdl_device_create(); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2569 } else { |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2570 #endif |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2571 fb_context = nk_rawfb_init(NULL, context, render_width(), render_height(), 0); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2572 render_set_ui_fb_resize_handler(fb_resize); |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2573 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2574 } |
b7768c58f0da
Initial stab at DPI scaling support
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2307
diff
changeset
|
2575 #endif |
1811
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2576 style_init(); |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2577 texture_init(); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2578 } |
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2579 |
1477
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2580 void show_pause_menu(void) |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2581 { |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2582 if (current_view == view_play) { |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2583 set_content_binding_state(0); |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2584 context->style.window.background = nk_rgba(0, 0, 0, 128); |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2585 context->style.window.fixed_background = nk_style_item_color(nk_rgba(0, 0, 0, 128)); |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2586 current_view = view_pause; |
1841
5d10b8494b02
WIP keyboard nav for Nuklear menus
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1831
diff
changeset
|
2587 context->input.selected_widget = 0; |
1980
81df9aa2de9b
Less hacky run on audio thread mode
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1910
diff
changeset
|
2588 system_request_exit(current_system, 1); |
1814
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2589 } else if (current_system && !set_binding) { |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2590 clear_view_stack(); |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2591 show_play_view(); |
8db3c043be00
Fix crash when pressing escape with no ROM loaded. Fix immediate cancel in keybinding view when mouse happens to be where the cancel button appears
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1812
diff
changeset
|
2592 } |
1477
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2593 } |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2594 |
1581
7121daaa48c2
Fix drag and drop when using Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1579
diff
changeset
|
2595 void show_play_view(void) |
7121daaa48c2
Fix drag and drop when using Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1579
diff
changeset
|
2596 { |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2597 set_content_binding_state(1); |
1581
7121daaa48c2
Fix drag and drop when using Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1579
diff
changeset
|
2598 current_view = view_play; |
1841
5d10b8494b02
WIP keyboard nav for Nuklear menus
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1831
diff
changeset
|
2599 context->input.selected_widget = 0; |
1581
7121daaa48c2
Fix drag and drop when using Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1579
diff
changeset
|
2600 } |
7121daaa48c2
Fix drag and drop when using Nuklear UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1579
diff
changeset
|
2601 |
1477
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2602 static uint8_t active; |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2603 uint8_t is_nuklear_active(void) |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2604 { |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2605 return active; |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2606 } |
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2607 |
1483
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2608 uint8_t is_nuklear_available(void) |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2609 { |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2610 /*if (!render_has_gl()) { |
1483
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2611 //currently no fallback if GL2 unavailable |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2612 return 0; |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2613 }*/ |
1483
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2614 char *style = tern_find_path(config, "ui\0style\0", TVAL_PTR).ptrval; |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2615 if (!style) { |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2616 return 1; |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2617 } |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2618 return strcmp(style, "rom") != 0; |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2619 } |
001120e91fed
Skip loading menu ROM if Nuklear UI is enabled. Allow disabling Nuklear UI in favor of old menu ROM both at compile time and in config. Fall back to ROM UI if GL is unavailable
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1482
diff
changeset
|
2620 |
1577
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2621 static void persist_config_exit(void) |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2622 { |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2623 if (config_dirty) { |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2624 persist_config(config); |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2625 } |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2626 } |
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2627 |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2628 ui_image *load_ui_image(char *name) |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2629 { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2630 uint32_t buf_size; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2631 uint8_t *buf = (uint8_t *)read_bundled_file(name, &buf_size); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2632 if (buf) { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2633 num_ui_images++; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2634 if (num_ui_images > ui_image_storage) { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2635 ui_image_storage = (ui_image_storage + 1) * 2; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2636 ui_images = realloc(ui_images, ui_image_storage * sizeof(*ui_images)); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2637 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2638 ui_image *this_image = ui_images[num_ui_images-1] = calloc(1, sizeof(ui_image)); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2639 this_image->image_data = load_png(buf, buf_size, &this_image->width, &this_image->height); |
1658
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2640 #ifdef USE_GLES |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2641 uint32_t *cur = this_image->image_data; |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2642 for (int i = 0; i < this_image->width*this_image->height; i++, cur++) |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2643 { |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2644 uint32_t pixel = *cur; |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2645 *cur = (pixel & 0xFF00FF00) | (pixel << 16 & 0xFF0000) | (pixel >> 16 & 0xFF); |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2646 } |
fa9ae059e4d3
Added support for GLES in addition to desktop GL
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1647
diff
changeset
|
2647 #endif |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2648 free(buf); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2649 if (!this_image->image_data) { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2650 num_ui_images--; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2651 free(this_image); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2652 return NULL; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2653 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2654 return this_image; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2655 } else { |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2656 return NULL; |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2657 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2658 } |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2659 |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2660 void blastem_nuklear_init(uint8_t file_loaded) |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2661 { |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2662 context = nk_sdl_init(render_get_window()); |
1825
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2663 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2664 if (render_has_gl()) { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2665 nk_sdl_device_create(); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2666 } else { |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2667 #endif |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2668 fb_context = nk_rawfb_init(NULL, context, render_width(), render_height(), 0); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2669 render_set_ui_fb_resize_handler(fb_resize); |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2670 #ifndef DISABLE_OPENGL |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2671 } |
56a1171e29b9
Allow Nuklear UI to be used when OpenGL is disabled
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1816
diff
changeset
|
2672 #endif |
1811
af14c21939f6
Add unit to gain label and change color of checkbox selected state to hopefully make it more clear
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1807
diff
changeset
|
2673 style_init(); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2674 |
1646
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2675 controller_360 = load_ui_image("images/360.png"); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2676 controller_ps4 = load_ui_image("images/ps4.png"); |
60b199cbb3f7
Added PS4 6-button fighting pad image and cleaned up controller image handling code
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1645
diff
changeset
|
2677 controller_ps4_6b = load_ui_image("images/ps4_6b.png"); |
2003
4c418ee9a9d8
Added Wii U controller image
Mike Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1980
diff
changeset
|
2678 controller_wiiu = load_ui_image("images/wiiu.png"); |
2020
e42c45ff06d5
Add Genesis 6-button contoller image
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2018
diff
changeset
|
2679 controller_gen_6b = load_ui_image("images/genesis_6b.png"); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2680 |
1570
bc96bb3a0998
Use read_bundle_file for controller PNG. Re-upload texture when GL context is recreated
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1569
diff
changeset
|
2681 texture_init(); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2682 |
1672
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2683 if (file_loaded) { |
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2684 current_view = view_play; |
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2685 } else { |
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2686 current_view = view_menu; |
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2687 set_content_binding_state(0); |
12d0c7c4ad80
Disable most bindings when UI is active
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1666
diff
changeset
|
2688 } |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2689 render_set_ui_render_fun(blastem_nuklear_render); |
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2690 render_set_event_handler(handle_event); |
1476
0646ae0987c3
Fix UI rendering in fullscreen and wome initial work on the "pause" menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1475
diff
changeset
|
2691 render_set_gl_context_handlers(context_destroyed, context_created); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2692 |
1577
69d624271cf8
Persist config on exit if config has changed
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1575
diff
changeset
|
2693 atexit(persist_config_exit); |
2202
ee6d30c56eeb
Add separate model/IO selection settings for SMS/GG
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
2162
diff
changeset
|
2694 |
1477
1cdd7f492af8
Pause menu now triggered on ui.exit event
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1476
diff
changeset
|
2695 active = 1; |
1486
a6881d0d76d0
Pause game execution when in the new UI pause menu
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
1485
diff
changeset
|
2696 ui_idle_loop(); |
1474
c5c022c7aa54
Initial work on Nuklear-based UI
Michael Pavone <pavone@retrodev.com>
parents:
diff
changeset
|
2697 } |